blob: ff90526d868fcd653c7b3d050c7c4ab20d0a6696 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
817Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100818
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200819 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
820 listen mwcli_px
821 bind :1111
822 ...
823 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100824
825Three other directives are provided to report some status:
826
827 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
828 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
829 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
830
831Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
832"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
833fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
834provide advice to the user.
835
836Example:
837
838 .if "${A}"
839 .if "${B}"
840 .notice "A=1, B=1"
841 .elif "${C}"
842 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
843 .elif "${D}"
844 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
845 .else
846 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
847 .endif
848 .else
849 .notice "A=0"
850 .endif
851
852
8532.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200854----------------
855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100856Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100857values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
858otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
859numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
860for every keyword. Supported units are :
861
862 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
863 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
864 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
865 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
866 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
867 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
868
869
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008702.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200871-------------
872
873 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
874 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
875 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
876 global
877 daemon
878 maxconn 256
879
880 defaults
881 mode http
882 timeout connect 5000ms
883 timeout client 50000ms
884 timeout server 50000ms
885
886 frontend http-in
887 bind *:80
888 default_backend servers
889
890 backend servers
891 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
892
893
894 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
895 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
896 global
897 daemon
898 maxconn 256
899
900 defaults
901 mode http
902 timeout connect 5000ms
903 timeout client 50000ms
904 timeout server 50000ms
905
906 listen http-in
907 bind *:80
908 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
909
910
911Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
912
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100913 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200914
915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917--------------------
918
919Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
920are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
921of them have command-line equivalents.
922
923The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
924
925 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200926 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200928 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200929 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200931 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200932 - description
933 - deviceatlas-json-file
934 - deviceatlas-log-level
935 - deviceatlas-separator
936 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900937 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200938 - gid
939 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100940 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200941 - h1-case-adjust
942 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100943 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100945 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200946 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200947 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200948 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100949 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200950 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100951 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100952 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200953 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200955 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200956 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100957 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200959 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100960 - presetenv
961 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - uid
963 - ulimit-n
964 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200965 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100966 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100967 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200968 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200969 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200970 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200971 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200972 - ssl-default-bind-options
973 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200974 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200975 - ssl-default-server-options
976 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100977 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200978 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100979 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100980 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100981 - 51degrees-data-file
982 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200983 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200984 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200985 - wurfl-data-file
986 - wurfl-information-list
987 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200988 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100989 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100990
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100992 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200993 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200995 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100996 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100997 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100998 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200999 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001000 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001001 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003 - noepoll
1004 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001005 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001007 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001008 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001009 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001010 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001011 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001012 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001013 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001014 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001015 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - tune.buffers.limit
1017 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001018 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001019 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001020 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001021 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001022 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001023 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001024 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001025 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001026 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001027 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001028 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001029 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001030 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001031 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001032 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1033 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001034 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001035 - tune.maxaccept
1036 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001037 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001038 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001039 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001040 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1041 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001042 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1043 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001044 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001045 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001046 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001047 - tune.sndbuf.client
1048 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001049 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001050 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001051 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001052 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001053 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001054 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001055 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001056 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001057 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001058 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001059 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1060 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1061 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001062 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1063 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001064
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001067 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010703.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071------------------------------------
1072
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001073ca-base <dir>
1074 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001075 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1076 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1077 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079chroot <jail dir>
1080 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1081 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1082 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1083 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1084 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001085 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001086
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001087cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1088 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1089 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1090 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1091 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1092 set. These sets have the format
1093
1094 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1095
1096 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001097 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1099 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001100 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1101 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001102 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1103 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1104 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1105 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1106 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1107 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1108 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1109 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1110 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1111 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001112
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001113 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1114 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1115 on the machine's word size.
1116
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001117 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001118 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1119 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1120 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1121 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1122 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1123 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001124
1125 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001126 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1127
1128 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1129 # first 4 CPUs
1130
1131 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1132 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1133 # word size.
1134
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001135 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001136 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001137 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1138 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1139 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1140
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001141 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1142 # and so on.
1143 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1144 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1145 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1146
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001147 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001148 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1149 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1150 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1151
1152 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1153 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1154 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1155
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1157 # and a thread range.
1158 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1159 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1160 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1161
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001162crt-base <dir>
1163 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001164 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1165 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001167daemon
1168 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1169 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001170 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1171 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001173default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1174 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1175 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1176 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1177 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1178 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1179 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1180 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1181 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1182 not start with a slash ('/'):
1183 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1184 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1185
1186 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1187 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1188 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1189 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1190 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1191 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1192 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1193 each of them.
1194
1195 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1196 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1197 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1198 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1199 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1200 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1201 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1202 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1203
1204 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1205 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1206 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1207 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1208 made easily relocatable.
1209
1210 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1211 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1212 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1213 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1214 consistent across all configuration files.
1215
1216 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1217 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1218 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1219 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1220 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1221 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1222 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1223 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1224
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001225deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1226 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001227 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001228
1229deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001230 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001231 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1232
1233deviceatlas-separator <char>
1234 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1235 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1236
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001237deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001238 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1239 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1240 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001241
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001242external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001243 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1244 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001245 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1246 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1247 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1248 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1249 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001250
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001251gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001252 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001253 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1254 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001255 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1256 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001257 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001258
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001259group <group name>
1260 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1261 See also "gid" and "user".
1262
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001263hard-stop-after <time>
1264 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1265
1266 Arguments :
1267 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1268 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1269 SIGUSR1 signal.
1270
1271 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1272 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1273 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1274
1275 Example:
1276 global
1277 hard-stop-after 30s
1278
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001279h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1280 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1281 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1282 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1283 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001284 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001285 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1286 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1287 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1288 specified in a proxy.
1289
1290 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1291 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1292 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1293 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1294 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1295 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1296 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1297
1298 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1299 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1300 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1301 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1302 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1303
1304 Example:
1305 global
1306 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1307
1308 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1309 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1310
1311h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1312 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1313 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1314 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1315 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1316 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1317 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1318 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1319 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1320
1321 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1322 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1323 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1324
1325 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1326 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1327
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001328insecure-fork-wanted
1329 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1330 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1331 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1332 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1333 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1334 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1335 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1336 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1337 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1338 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1339 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1340 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1341 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1342 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1343 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1344 disable it.
1345
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001346insecure-setuid-wanted
1347 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1348 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1349 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1350 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1351 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1352 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1353 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1354 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1355 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1356 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1357 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1358 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1359 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1360 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1361
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001362issuers-chain-path <dir>
1363 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1364 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1365 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1366 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1367 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1368 "issuers-chain-path".
1369 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1370 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1371 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1372 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1373 will share the chain in memory.
1374
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001375localpeer <name>
1376 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1377 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1378 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1379 the configuration parsing.
1380
1381 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1382 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1383
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001384log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001385 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001386 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001387 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001388 configured with "log global".
1389
1390 <address> can be one of:
1391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001392 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001393 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1394 port).
1395
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001396 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1397 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1398 port).
1399
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001400 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001401 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1402 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001403 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001404
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001405 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1406 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1407 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1408 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1409 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1410 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1411 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1412 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1413 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1414 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1415 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1416 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1417 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1418 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001419 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1420 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001421
1422 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1423 "fd@2", see above.
1424
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001425 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1426 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1427 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1428 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1429 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001431 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1432 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001433
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001434 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1435 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1436 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1437 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1438 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1439 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1440 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1441 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1442 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1443 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001444 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1445 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001446
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001447 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1448 one of the following :
1449
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001450 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1451 field is stripped. This is the default.
1452 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1453 rfc3164.
1454
1455 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001456 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1457
1458 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1459 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1460
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001461 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1462 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1463 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1464 designed to be used with a local log server.
1465
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001466 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1467 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1468 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1469 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1470 logger consumes.
1471
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001472 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1473 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1474 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1475 used with a local log server.
1476
1477 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1478 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1479 designed to be used with a local log server.
1480
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001481 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1482 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1483 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1484 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1485
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001486 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1487 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1488 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1489 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1490 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1491
1492 <sample_size>
1493 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1494 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1495 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1496 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1497 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1498
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001499 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001500
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001501 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1502 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1503 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1504
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001505 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1506 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1507 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1508 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001509
1510 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001511 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1512 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1513 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1514 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1515 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1516 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001518 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001519
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001520log-send-hostname [<string>]
1521 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1522 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1523 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1524 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1525 the logs.
1526
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001527log-tag <string>
1528 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1529 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1530 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001531 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001532
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001533lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001534 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1535 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1536 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1537 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1538 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1539 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001540 used multiple times.
1541
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001542lua-load-per-thread <file>
1543 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1544 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1545 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1546 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1547 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1548 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1549 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1550 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1551 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1552 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1553 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1554 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1555 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1556 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1557 times.
1558
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001559lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1560 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1561 variable.
1562 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1563 to "path".
1564
1565 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1566 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1567 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1568 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1569 will be checked earlier.
1570
1571 As an example by specifying the following path:
1572
1573 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1574 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1575
1576 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1577 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1578 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1579 paths if that does not exist either.
1580
1581 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1582 documentation.
1583
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001584master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001585 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1586 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1587 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001588 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001589 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1590 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001591 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1592 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1593 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1594 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1595 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001596
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001597 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001598
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001599mworker-max-reloads <number>
1600 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001601 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001602 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1603 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1604 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1605
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001606nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001607 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1608 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1609 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001610 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1611 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001612 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1613 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1614 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001615
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001616nbthread <number>
1617 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001618 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1619 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1620 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1621 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1622 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001623 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1624 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1625 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1626 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1627 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1628 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1629 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001630
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001631numa-cpu-mapping
1632 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1633 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1634 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1635 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1636 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1637 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1638 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1639 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1640 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001642pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001643 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1644 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1645 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1646 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001647
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001648pp2-never-send-local
1649 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1650 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1651 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1652 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1653 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1654 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1655 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1656 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1657 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1658 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1659 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1660
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001661presetenv <name> <value>
1662 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1663 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1664 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1665 and "unsetenv".
1666
1667resetenv [<name> ...]
1668 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1669 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1670 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1671 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1672 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1673 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1674 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1675 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1676
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001677stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001678 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1679 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1680 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1681 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1682 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1683 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001684 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001685 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1686 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1687 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1688 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001689
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001690server-state-base <directory>
1691 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001692 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1693 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001694
1695server-state-file <file>
1696 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1697 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1698 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1699 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1700 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1701 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1702 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1703 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001704 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1705 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001706
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001707set-var <var-name> <expr>
1708 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1709 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1710 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1711 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1712 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1713 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1714 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1715 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1716 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1717
1718 Example:
1719 global
1720 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1721 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1722 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1723
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001724setenv <name> <value>
1725 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1726 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1727 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1728 and "unsetenv".
1729
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001730set-dumpable
1731 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001732 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1733 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1734 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1735 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1736 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1737 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1738 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1739 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1740 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1741 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1742 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1743 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1744 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1745 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1746 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1747 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1748 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001749
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001750ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1752 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001753 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001754 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001755 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1756 information and recommendations see e.g.
1757 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1758 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1759 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1760 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001761
1762ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1764 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1765 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1766 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1767 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001768 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1769 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1770 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001771 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001772
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001773ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1775 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1776 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1777 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1778 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1779
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001780ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1782 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1783 keyword to see available options.
1784
1785 Example:
1786 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001787 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001788
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001789ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1791 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001792 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001793 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001794 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1795 information and recommendations see e.g.
1796 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1797 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1798 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1799 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1800 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001801
1802ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1804 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1805 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1806 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1807 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001808 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1809 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1810 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1811 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001812
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001813ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1815 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1816 keyword to see available options.
1817
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001818ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1820 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1821 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001822 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001823 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001824 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1825 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1826 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1827 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001828 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1829 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1830 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1831
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001832ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1833 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1834 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001835 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001836 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001837 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1838
1839 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001840
1841 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1842 and won't try to remove them.
1843
1844 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1845
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001846ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001847 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001848 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1849 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001850
1851 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1852 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1853 optimize the startup time.
1854
1855 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1856 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1857 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1858
1859 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001860 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001861
1862 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001863 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1864
1865 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1866 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1867 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1868 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1869 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1870 bind configuration..
1871
1872 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1873 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1874 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1875 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1876 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1877 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1878 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1879 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1880
1881 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1882
1883 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1884 a cert bundle.
1885
1886 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1887 separately in several "crt".
1888
1889 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1890 since files are loading separately.
1891
1892 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1893 required to commit them.
1894
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001895 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001896 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001897
1898 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1899
1900 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1901
1902 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1903 not provided in the PEM file.
1904
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001905 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1906 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1907
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001908 The default behavior is "all".
1909
1910 Example:
1911 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1912 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1913 ssl-load-extra-files none
1914
1915 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1916
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001917ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1918 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1919 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1920 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1921
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001922ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001923 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001924 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1925 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1926 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1927 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1928 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1929 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001930 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001931
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001932stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1933 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1934 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1935 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001936 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001937 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001938
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001939 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1940 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1941 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001942
1943stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1944 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1945 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001946 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001947
1948stats maxconn <connections>
1949 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1950 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001952uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001953 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001954 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1955 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1956 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1957
1958ulimit-n <number>
1959 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1960 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1961 option.
1962
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001963unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1964 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1965
1966 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1967 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1968 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1969 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1970 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1971 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1972 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1973 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1974 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1975 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1976
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001977unsetenv [<name> ...]
1978 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1979 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1980 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1981 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1982 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1983 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1984 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001986user <user name>
1987 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1988 See also "uid" and "group".
1989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001990node <name>
1991 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1992
1993 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1994 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1995 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1996 traffic.
1997
1998description <text>
1999 Add a text that describes the instance.
2000
2001 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2002 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2003 "<" and ">" characters.
2004
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100200551degrees-data-file <file path>
2006 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002007 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002008
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002009 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002010 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2011
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000201251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002013 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2014 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2015 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2016
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002017 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002018 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2019
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200202051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002021 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2022 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2023
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002024 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2025 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2026
202751degrees-cache-size <number>
2028 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2029 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2030 By default, this cache is disabled.
2031
2032 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002033 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2034
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002035wurfl-data-file <file path>
2036 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2037 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2038
2039 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2040 with USE_WURFL=1.
2041
2042wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2043 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2044 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2045 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2046
2047 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2048
2049 Valid WURFL properties are:
2050 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2051
2052 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2053 device.
2054
2055 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2056 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2057
2058 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2059 particular web request.
2060
2061 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2062 used Libwurfl API version.
2063
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002064 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2065 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2066
2067 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2068 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2069
2070 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2071
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002072 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2073 with USE_WURFL=1.
2074
2075wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2076 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2077 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2078
2079 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2080 with USE_WURFL=1.
2081
2082wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2083 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2084 thus before the chroot.
2085
2086 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2087 with USE_WURFL=1.
2088
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002089wurfl-cache-size <size>
2090 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2091 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002092 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002093 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002094
2095 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2096 with USE_WURFL=1.
2097
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002098strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002099 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2100 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2101 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2102 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2103 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021053.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002106-----------------------
2107
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002108busy-polling
2109 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2110 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2111 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2112 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2113 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2114 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2115 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2116 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2117 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2118 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2119 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2120 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2121 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2122 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2123 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2124 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2125 "poll" pollers.
2126
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002127 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2128 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2129 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2130
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002131max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2132 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2133 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2134 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2135 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2136 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2137 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2138 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2139 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141maxconn <number>
2142 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2143 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2144 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002145 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2146 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2147 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2148 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002149 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2150 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2151 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2152 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2153 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2154 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002155
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002156maxconnrate <number>
2157 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2158 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2159 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2160 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2161 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2162 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2163 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2164 fairness.
2165
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002166maxcomprate <number>
2167 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002168 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002169 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2170 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2171 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002173 default value.
2174
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002175maxcompcpuusage <number>
2176 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2177 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2178 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2179 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2180 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2181 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2182 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2183 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2184
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002185maxpipes <number>
2186 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2187 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2188 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2189 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2190 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2191 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2192
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002193maxsessrate <number>
2194 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2195 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2196 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2197 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2198 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2199 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2200 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2201 fairness.
2202
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002203maxsslconn <number>
2204 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2205 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2206 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2207 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2208 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2209 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2210 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002211 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2212 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2213 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2214 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2215 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2216 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2217 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002218
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002219maxsslrate <number>
2220 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2221 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2222 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2223 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2224 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2225 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2226 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2227 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2228 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2229 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2230
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002231maxzlibmem <number>
2232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2233 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2234 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002235 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2236 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2237 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2238
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002239noepoll
2240 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2241 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002242 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002243
2244nokqueue
2245 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2246 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2247 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2248
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002249noevports
2250 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2251 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2252 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2253 also "nopoll".
2254
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255nopoll
2256 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2257 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002259 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2260 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002261
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002262nosplice
2263 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002264 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002265 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002266 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002267 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2268 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2269 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2270 "option splice-response".
2271
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002272nogetaddrinfo
2273 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2274 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2275
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002276noreuseport
2277 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2278 command line argument "-dR".
2279
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002280profiling.memory { on | off }
2281 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2282 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2283 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2284 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2285 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2286 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2287 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2288 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2289 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2290
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002291profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2292 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2293 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2294 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2295 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002296 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002297 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2298 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2299 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2300 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2301
2302 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2303 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2304 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2305 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2306 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002307 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2308 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2309 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2310 CLI.
2311
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002312spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002313 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2314 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2315 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2316 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2317 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2318 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002319
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002321 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002322 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002323 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2324 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2325 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2326 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2327 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002328 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2329 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002330 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2331 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2332 openssl configuration file uses:
2333 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2334
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002335ssl-mode-async
2336 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002337 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002338 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2339 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2340 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002341 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002342 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002343
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002344tune.buffers.limit <number>
2345 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2346 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2347 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2348 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2349 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002350 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002351 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2352 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2353 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2354 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2355 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2356 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2357 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2358 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2359 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2360
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002361tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2362 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2363 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2364 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2365 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2366
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002367tune.bufsize <number>
2368 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2369 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2370 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2371 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2372 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2373 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2374 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002375 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2376 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2377 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002378 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002379 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2380 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2381 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002382
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002383tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2384 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002385
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002386tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2387 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2388 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2389 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2390 this value. The default value is 1.
2391
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002392tune.fail-alloc
2393 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2394 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2395 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2396 gracefully.
2397
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002398tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2399 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2400 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2401 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2402 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2403 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2404
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002405tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2406 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2407 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2408 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2409 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2410 change it.
2411
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002412tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2413 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002414 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2415 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002416 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2417 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2418 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2419 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2420 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2421
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002422tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2423 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2424 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2425 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2426 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2427 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2428 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2429 recommended not to change this value.
2430
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002431tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2432 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2433 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2434 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2435 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2436 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2437 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2438 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2439
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002440tune.http.cookielen <number>
2441 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2442 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2443 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2444 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2445 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2446 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2447 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2448 to change this value.
2449
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002450tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002451 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2452 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002453 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002454 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002455 configuration directives too.
2456 The default value is 1024.
2457
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002458tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2459 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2460 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2461 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2462 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2463 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2464 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002465 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2466 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2467 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002468
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002469tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2470 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2471 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2472 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2473 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2474 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2475 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002476 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2477 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2478 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2479 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2480 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002481
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002482tune.idletimer <timeout>
2483 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2484 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2485 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2486 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2487 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2488 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002489 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002490 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002491 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2492
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002493tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2494 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2495 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2496 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2497 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2498 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2499 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2500 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2501 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2502 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2503
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002504tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2505 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002506 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002507 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2508 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002509 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002510 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2511 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2512
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002513tune.lua.maxmem
2514 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2515 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2516 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2517 memory.
2518
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002519tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2520 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002521 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2522 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002523 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002524
2525tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2526 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2527 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2528 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2529 check servers.
2530
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002531tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2532 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2533 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2534 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002535 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002536
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002537tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002538 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2539 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002540 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2541 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2542 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2543 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2544 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2545 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2546 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2547 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2548 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002549
2550tune.maxpollevents <number>
2551 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2552 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2553 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2554 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2555 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2556
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002557tune.maxrewrite <number>
2558 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2559 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2560 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2561 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2562 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2563 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2564 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2565 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2566 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2567 bufsize.
2568
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002569tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2570 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2571 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2572 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2573 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2574 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2575 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2576 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2577 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2578 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002579 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2580 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002581 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2582 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2583 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2584 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2585 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2586 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2587 setting this parameter to 0.
2588
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002589tune.pipesize <number>
2590 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2591 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2592 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2593 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2594 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2595 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2596
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002597tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2598 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2599 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2600 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2601 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2602 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2603 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002604 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002605
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002606tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2607 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2608 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2609 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2610 default is 20.
2611
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002612tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2613tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2614 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2615 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2616 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002617 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002618 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002619 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2620 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2621
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002622tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002623 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002624 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2625 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2626 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2627 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2628
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002629tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002630 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002631 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2632 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2633 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2634 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2635 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2636 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2637 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002638
2639tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2640 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2641 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2642 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2643 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2644 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2645 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2646 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2647 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2648 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002649
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002650tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2651tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2652 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2653 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2654 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002655 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002656 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002657 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2658 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2659 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2660 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2661 notifying haproxy again.
2662
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002663tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002664 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002665 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2666 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2667 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2668 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2669 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2670 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2671 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2672 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2673 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2674 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2675 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002676
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002677tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002678 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002679 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2680 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2681 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2682 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2683 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2684
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002685tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2686 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2687 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2688 performances. This is disabled by default.
2689
2690 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2691 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2692
2693 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2694
2695 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2696
2697 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2698
2699 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2700 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2701 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2702
2703 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2704 converted.
2705
2706 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2707 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2708 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2709 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2710 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2711 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2712 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002713 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2714 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002715
2716 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2717
2718 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2719 only need this line:
2720
2721 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2722
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002723tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2724 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002725 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002726 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2727 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2728 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2729 being used for too long.
2730
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002731tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2732 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2733 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2734 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2735 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2736 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2737 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2738 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2739 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2740 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2741 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002742 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002743 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002744
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002745tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2746 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2747 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2748 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2749 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002750 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002751 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2752 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002753 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2754 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002755
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002756tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2757 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2758 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2759 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2760 1000 entries.
2761
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002762tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2763 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2764 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2765 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2766
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002767tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002768tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002769tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2770tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2771tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002772 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2773 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2774 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2775 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2776 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2777 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2778 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2779 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002780
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002781 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2782 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2783 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2784 all available space is consumed.
2785 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2786 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2787 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002788
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002789tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2790 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002791 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002792 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002793 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002794 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2795
2796tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2797 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2798 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002799 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2800 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028023.3. Debugging
2803--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002805quiet
2806 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2807 line argument "-q".
2808
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002809zero-warning
2810 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2811 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2812 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2813 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2814 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2815 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2816
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028183.4. Userlists
2819--------------
2820It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2821http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2822it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2823
2824userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002825 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002826 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2827
2828group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002829 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002830 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2831 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2832
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002833user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2834 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002835 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2836 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002837 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2838 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2839 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2840 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002841
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002842 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2843 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2844 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2845 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2846 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2847 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2848 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2849 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2850 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002851
2852 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002853 userlist L1
2854 group G1 users tiger,scott
2855 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002857 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2858 user scott insecure-password elgato
2859 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002861 userlist L2
2862 group G1
2863 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002864
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002865 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2866 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2867 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002868
2869 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002870
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002871
28723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002873----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002874It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2875several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2876instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2877values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2878automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2879In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2880using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2881tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2882reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2883Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2884that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2885each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002886
2887peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002888 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002889 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2890
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002891bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2892 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2893 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2894
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002895disabled
2896 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2897 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2898 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2899
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002900default-bind [param*]
2901 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2902
2903default-server [param*]
2904 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2905
2906 Arguments:
2907 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2908 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2909 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2910 details.
2911
2912
2913 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2914
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002915enable
2916 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2917
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002918log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002919 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2920 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2921 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2922 more details.
2923
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002924peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002925 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2926 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002927 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2928 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2929 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2930 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2931 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002932
2933 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2934 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2935
2936 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002937 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2938 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2939 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002940
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002941 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2942 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002943
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002944 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2945 "server" keyword explanation below).
2946
2947server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002948 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2950 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2951 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2952 of this "peers" section).
2953 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2954
2955
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002956 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002957 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002958 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002959 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2960 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2961 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002962
2963 backend mybackend
2964 mode tcp
2965 balance roundrobin
2966 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2967 stick on src
2968
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002969 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2970 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002972 Example:
2973 peers mypeers
2974 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2975 default-server ssl verify none
2976 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2977 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002978
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002979
2980table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2981 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2982
2983 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2984 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002985 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002986 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2987 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2988 "stick-table" keyword).
2989
2990 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2991 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2992 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2993 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2994 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2995 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2996 of the stick-table name as follows:
2997
2998 peers mypeers
2999 peer A ...
3000 peer B ...
3001 table t1 ...
3002
3003 frontend fe1
3004 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3005
3006 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3007 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3008
3009 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3010 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3011 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3012 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3013 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3014 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3015 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3016
3017 peers mypeers
3018 peer A ...
3019 peer B ...
3020 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3021
3022 backend t1
3023 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3024
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003025 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003026 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3027 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3028
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030293.6. Mailers
3030------------
3031It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3032If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3033in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3034
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003035mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003036 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3037 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3038
3039mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3040 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3041
3042 Example:
3043 mailers mymailers
3044 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3045 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3046
3047 backend mybackend
3048 mode tcp
3049 balance roundrobin
3050
3051 email-alert mailers mymailers
3052 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3053 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3054
3055 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3056 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3057
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003058timeout mail <time>
3059 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3060 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3061 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3062 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3063
3064 Example:
3065 mailers mymailers
3066 timeout mail 20s
3067 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003068
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020030693.7. Programs
3070-------------
3071In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3072master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3073managed the same way as the workers.
3074
3075During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3076sequence as a worker:
3077
3078 - the master is re-executed
3079 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3080 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3081 instance of the program
3082
3083During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3084
3085program <name>
3086 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3087 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3088 the management guide).
3089
3090command <command> [arguments*]
3091 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3092 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3093 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3094 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3095
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003096user <user name>
3097 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3098 See also "group".
3099
3100group <group name>
3101 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3102 See also "user".
3103
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003104option start-on-reload
3105no option start-on-reload
3106 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3107 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3108 program section.
3109
3110
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031113.8. HTTP-errors
3112----------------
3113
3114It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3115imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3116several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3117
3118http-errors <name>
3119 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3120 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3121
3122errorfile <code> <file>
3123 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3124
3125 Arguments :
3126 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003127 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003128 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003129
3130 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3131 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3132 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3133 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3134 before any chroot is performed.
3135
3136 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3137
3138 Example:
3139 http-errors website-1
3140 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3141 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3142 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3143
3144 http-errors website-2
3145 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3146 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3147 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3148
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031493.9. Rings
3150----------
3151
3152It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3153servers or traces.
3154
3155ring <ringname>
3156 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3157
3158description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003159 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003160 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3161
3162format <format>
3163 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3164
3165 Arguments:
3166 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3167 one of the following :
3168
3169 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3170 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3171 designed to be used with a local log server.
3172
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003173 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3174 field is stripped. This is the default.
3175 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3176 rfc3164.
3177
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003178 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3179 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3180 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3181 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3182 is the default.
3183
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003184 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003185 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3186
3187 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3188 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3189
3190 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3191 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3192 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3193 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3194 logger consumes.
3195
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003196 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3197 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3198 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3199 with a local log server.
3200
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003201 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3202 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3203 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3204 used with a local log server.
3205
3206maxlen <length>
3207 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3208 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3209 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3210
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003211server <name> <address> [param*]
3212 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3213 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3214 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3215 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3216 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3217 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3218 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3219 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3220 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003221 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3222 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003223
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003224size <size>
3225 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3226 set to BUFSIZE.
3227
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003228timeout connect <timeout>
3229 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3230
3231 Arguments :
3232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3234 as explained at the top of this document.
3235
3236timeout server <timeout>
3237 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3238
3239 Arguments :
3240 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3241 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3242 as explained at the top of this document.
3243
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003244 Example:
3245 global
3246 log ring@myring local7
3247
3248 ring myring
3249 description "My local buffer"
3250 format rfc3164
3251 maxlen 1200
3252 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003253 timeout connect 5s
3254 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003255 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003256
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032573.10. Log forwarding
3258-------------------
3259
3260It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3261haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3262
3263log-forward <name>
3264 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3265
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003266backlog <conns>
3267 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3268 on connections accept.
3269
3270bind <addr> [param*]
3271 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003272 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3273 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3274 syslog protocol over TCP.
3275 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003276 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3277
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003278dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003279 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3280 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3281 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3282 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003283 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003284
3285log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003286log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003287 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3288 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3289 documentation.
3290 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3291 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3292 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3293 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3294 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3295
3296 Example:
3297 global
3298 log stderr format iso local7
3299
3300 ring myring
3301 description "My local buffer"
3302 format rfc5424
3303 maxlen 1200
3304 size 32764
3305 timeout connect 5s
3306 timeout server 10s
3307 # syslog tcp server
3308 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3309
3310 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003311 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3312 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003313 # all messages on stderr
3314 log global
3315 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3316 log ring@myring local0
3317 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3318 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3319 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3320 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3321 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003322
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003323maxconn <conns>
3324 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3325 10 is the default.
3326
3327timeout client <timeout>
3328 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033304. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003331----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003333Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003334 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3335 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3336 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3337 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003338
3339A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3340connections.
3341
3342A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3343to forward incoming connections.
3344
3345A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3346parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3347
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003348A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3349ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3350sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3351the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3352explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3353from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3354"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3355for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3356to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3357optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3358are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3359any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3360names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3361that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3362duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3363names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3364
3365Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3366settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3367of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3368profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3369timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3372'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3373case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3374
3375Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3376logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3377proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3378However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3379name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3380
3381Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3382and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003383bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3385modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3386arbitrary criteria.
3387
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003388In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3389a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003390the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003391
3392 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3393 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3394 between responses and new requests.
3395
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003396 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3397 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3398 client-facing connection remains open.
3399
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003400 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3401 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003402
3403The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3404frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3405following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003406weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003407
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003408 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003409
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003410 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3411 ----+-----+-----+----
3412 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3413 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003414 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3415 ----+-----+-----+----
3416 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003417
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003418It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3419only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3420into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3421as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3422content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3423and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3424possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003426There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3427first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3428processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3429second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3430protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3431is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3432new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3433to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3434process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3435already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3436HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3437evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3438one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3439
3440There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3441performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3442tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3443preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3444analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3445HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3446header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3447mitigate this drawback.
3448
3449It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3450method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3451set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3452in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3453is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3454to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3455above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3456to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3457"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3458frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3459frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3460as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3461upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3462on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3463the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3464upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3465frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3466remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3469--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003471The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3472limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3473they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3474limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003476option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003477and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3478with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3479specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003481
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003482 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3483------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3484acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485backlog X X X -
3486balance X - X X
3487bind - X X -
3488bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003489capture cookie - X X -
3490capture request header - X X -
3491capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003492clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3493clitcpka-idle X X X -
3494clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003495compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003497declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003498default-server X - X X
3499default_backend X X X -
3500description - X X X
3501disabled X X X X
3502dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003503email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003504email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003505email-alert mailers X X X X
3506email-alert myhostname X X X X
3507email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003508enabled X X X X
3509errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003510errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003511errorloc X X X X
3512errorloc302 X X X X
3513-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3514errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003515force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003516filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003517fullconn X - X X
3518grace X X X X
3519hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003520http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003521http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003522http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003523http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003524http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003525http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003526http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003527http-check set-var X - X X
3528http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003529http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003530http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003531http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003532http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003533http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003535ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003536load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003537log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003538log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003539log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003540log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003541max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003542maxconn X X X -
3543mode X X X X
3544monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545monitor-uri X X X -
3546option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3547option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3548option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3549option allbackups (*) X - X X
3550option checkcache (*) X - X X
3551option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3552option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003553option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3555option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003556-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3557option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003558option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3559option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003560option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003561option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003562option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003563option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003564option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3566option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3567option httpchk X - X X
3568option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003569option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003571option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003572option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003573option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3575option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3576option logasap (*) X X X -
3577option mysql-check X - X X
3578option nolinger (*) X X X X
3579option originalto X X X X
3580option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003581option pgsql-check X - X X
3582option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003584option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585option smtpchk X - X X
3586option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3587option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3588option splice-request (*) X X X X
3589option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003590option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3592option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3593-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003594option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003595option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3596option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3597option tcpka X X X X
3598option tcplog X X X X
3599option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003600external-check command X - X X
3601external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3603rate-limit sessions X X X -
3604redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003607retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003608server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003609server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003610server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003612srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3613srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3614srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003615stats admin - X X X
3616stats auth X X X X
3617stats enable X X X X
3618stats hide-version X X X X
3619stats http-request - X X X
3620stats realm X X X X
3621stats refresh X X X X
3622stats scope X X X X
3623stats show-desc X X X X
3624stats show-legends X X X X
3625stats show-node X X X X
3626stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003627-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3628stick match - - X X
3629stick on - - X X
3630stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003631stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003632stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003633tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003634tcp-check connect X - X X
3635tcp-check expect X - X X
3636tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003637tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003638tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003639tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003640tcp-check set-var X - X X
3641tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003642tcp-request connection - X X -
3643tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003644tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003645tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003646tcp-response content - - X X
3647tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648timeout check X - X X
3649timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003650timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003652timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3653timeout http-request X X X X
3654timeout queue X - X X
3655timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003656timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003658timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003659transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003660unique-id-format X X X -
3661unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003662use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003663use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003664use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3666 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3670---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3673
3674
3675acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3676 Declare or complete an access list.
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 no | yes | yes | yes
3679 Example:
3680 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3681 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3682 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003684 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
3686
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003687backlog <conns>
3688 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | yes | yes | no
3691 Arguments :
3692 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3693 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003694 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003695
3696 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3697 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3698 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3699 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3700 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3701 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3702 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3703 backlog parameter.
3704
3705 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3706 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3707 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3708
3709 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3710
3711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003712balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003713balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003714 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | no | yes | yes
3717 Arguments :
3718 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3719 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3720 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3721 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3722
3723 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3724 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3725 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3726 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003727 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003728 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003729 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3730 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3731 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3732 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3733 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3734 it, so that you don't worry.
3735
3736 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3737 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3738 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3739 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3740 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3741 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3742 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3743 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003745 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3746 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3747 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3748 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3749 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3750 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3751 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003752 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3753 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3754 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003755
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003756 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003757 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003758 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3759 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003760 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003761 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3762 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3763 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3764 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3765 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003766 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3767 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3768 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3769 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3770 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3771 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3774 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3775 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3776 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3777 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3778 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3779 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3780 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003781 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003783 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3784 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3785 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003787 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3788 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3789 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3790 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3791 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3792 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3793 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3794 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3795 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3796 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3797 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3798 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003800 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003801 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3802 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3803 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3804 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3805 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3806 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3807 URIs start with a leading "/".
3808
3809 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3810 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3811 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3812 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3813
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003814 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3815 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3816 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3817 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3821
3822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003832
3833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3836 server will receive the request.
3837
3838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3861
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003862 random
3863 random(<draws>)
3864 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003865 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3866 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3867 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3868 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003869 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3870 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3871 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3872 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3873 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3874 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3875 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3876 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3877 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3878 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3879 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3880 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3881 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3882 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3883 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3884 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3885 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3886 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3887 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3888 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003889
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003890 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003891 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003892 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3893 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3894 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3895 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3896 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3897 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003898 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003899 used instead.
3900
3901 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3902 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3903 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3904 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3909
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003910 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003913 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3914 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003915
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003916 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3917 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3918 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003920 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003921 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003922 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3923 NTLM relies on.
3924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003925 Examples :
3926 balance roundrobin
3927 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003928 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003929 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3930 balance hdr(host)
3931 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003932
3933 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3934 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003936 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003937 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3938 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3939 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003940 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003941
3942 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3943 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3944 defaults to 16 kB.
3945
3946 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3947 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3948
3949 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3950 Round Robin.
3951
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003952 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003953 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3954 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3955 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3956
3957 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3958
3959 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003960 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003961 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3962 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3963 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003964
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003965 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966
3967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003968bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3969bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003970 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 no | yes | yes | no
3973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003974 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3975 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3976 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3977 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003978 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003979 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3980 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3981 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3982 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3983 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3984 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003985 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003986 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3987 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003988 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003989 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3990 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003991 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003992 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3993 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003994 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003995 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3996 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3997 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3998 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3999 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4000 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4001 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004002 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4003 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4004 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004005 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4006 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4007 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4008 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004009 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4010 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4011 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004012
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004013 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4014 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004015 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4016 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4017 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004018 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4019 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4020 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4021 the range.
4022
4023 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4024 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4025 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4026 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4027 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4028 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4029 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004030 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004031 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004032
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004033 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004034 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004035 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4036 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4037 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4038 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4039 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4040 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4041
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004042 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4043 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4044 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4045 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4048 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4049 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4050 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4051 in a frontend.
4052
4053 Example :
4054 listen http_proxy
4055 bind :80,:443
4056 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004057 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004059 listen http_https_proxy
4060 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004061 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004062
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004063 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4064 bind ipv6@:80
4065 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4066 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4067
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004068 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004069 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004070
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004071 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4072 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4073 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4074 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4075 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4076
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004077 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004078 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079
4080
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004081bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004082 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 yes | yes | yes | yes
4085 Arguments :
4086 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4087 may be used to override a default value.
4088
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004089 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004090 option may be combined with other numbers.
4091
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004092 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004093 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4094 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4095 missing from all processes.
4096
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004097 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004098 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004099 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4100 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4101 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4102 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4103 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004104 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004105
4106 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4107 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4108 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4109 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4110 and 'even' instances.
4111
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004112 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4113 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4114 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4115 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004116
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004117 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4118 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4119
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004120 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4121 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4122 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4123
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004124 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4125 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4126
4127 Example :
4128 listen app_ip1
4129 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004130 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004131
4132 listen app_ip2
4133 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004134 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004135
4136 listen management
4137 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004138 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004139
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004140 listen management
4141 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4142 bind-process 1-4
4143
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004144 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004145
4146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147capture cookie <name> len <length>
4148 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4150 no | yes | yes | no
4151 Arguments :
4152 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4153 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4154 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4155 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004156 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157
4158 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4159 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4160 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4161 right if it exceeds <length>.
4162
4163 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4164 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4165 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4166 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4167
4168 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4169 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4170 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4171
4172 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4173 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4174 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004175 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4176 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4177 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178
4179 Example:
4180 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4181
4182 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004183 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004184
4185
4186capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004187 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4189 no | yes | yes | no
4190 Arguments :
4191 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004192 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4194 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4195 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4196
4197 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4198 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4199 it exceeds <length>.
4200
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004201 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004202 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4203 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004204 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4205 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4206 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4207 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004208 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004209 environments to find where the request came from.
4210
4211 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4212 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4213 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4214 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004216 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4217 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4218 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4219 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4220 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221
4222 Example:
4223 capture request header Host len 15
4224 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004225 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004227 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 about logging.
4229
4230
4231capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004232 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4234 no | yes | yes | no
4235 Arguments :
4236 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004237 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4239 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4240 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4241
4242 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4243 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4244 it exceeds <length>.
4245
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004246 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004247 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4248 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4249 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004250 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4251 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4252 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4253 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004254
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004255 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4256 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4257 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4258 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4259 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004260
4261 Example:
4262 capture response header Content-length len 9
4263 capture response header Location len 15
4264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004265 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266 about logging.
4267
4268
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004269clitcpka-cnt <count>
4270 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4271 the connection on the client side.
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments :
4275 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4276
4277 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4278 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004279 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4280 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004281
4282 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4283
4284
4285clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4286 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4287 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4288 client side.
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | yes | yes | no
4291 Arguments :
4292 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4293 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4294 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4295 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4296
4297 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4298 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004299 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4300 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004301
4302 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4303
4304
4305clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4306 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4308 yes | yes | yes | no
4309 Arguments :
4310 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4311 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4312 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4313 document.
4314
4315 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4316 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004317 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4318 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004319
4320 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4321
4322
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004323compression algo <algorithm> ...
4324compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004325compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004326 Enable HTTP compression.
4327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | yes | yes | yes
4329 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004330 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4331 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4332 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4333
4334 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004335 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4336 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4337 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004338
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004339 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004340 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004341
4342 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4343 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4344 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4345 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4346 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004347 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004348
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004349 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4350 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4351 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4352 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4353 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4354 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4355 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004356 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004357
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004358 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004359 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004360 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4361 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4362 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4363 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4364 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004365
4366 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4367 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4368 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4369 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4370 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004371 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4372 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4373 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4374 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4375 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004376 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4377 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004378
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004379 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004380 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4381 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004382 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004383 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004384 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4385 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4386 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4387 "multipart"
4388 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4389 header
4390 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4391 and later
4392 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4393 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004394 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004395
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004396 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004397
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004398 Examples :
4399 compression algo gzip
4400 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004401
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004402
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004403cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004404 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4405 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004406 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004407 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 yes | no | yes | yes
4410 Arguments :
4411 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4412 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4413 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4414 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4415 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4416 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004417 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004418 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4419 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4420
4421 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4422 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4423 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4424 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4425 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4426 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004427 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4428 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004429 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004430 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4431 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432
4433 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004434 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004435
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004436 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004437 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004438 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004439 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004440 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4441 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4442 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4443 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4444 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4445 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4446 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004447
4448 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4449 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4450 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4451 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4452 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4453 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4454 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4455 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4456 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004457 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004458 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4459 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4460 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004461
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004462 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4463 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4464 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004465 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4466 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4467 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4468 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004469 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4470 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4471 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
4473 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4474 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4475 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4476 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4477 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4478 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4479 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4480 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4481 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4482
4483 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4484 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4485 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4486 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4487 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4488 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4489 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4490 persistence cookie in the cache.
4491 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4492
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004493 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4494 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4495 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4496 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4497 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004498 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004499 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4500 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4501 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4502 they logout.
4503
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004504 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4505 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4506 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4507 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4508
4509 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4510 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4511 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4512 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4513 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4514 this attribute.
4515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004516 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004517 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004518 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4519 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4520 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4521 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4522 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4523 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004524
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004525 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4526 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4527 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4528 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4529 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4530 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4531 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4532 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004534 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4535 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4536 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4537 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4538 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4539 the site.
4540
4541 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4542 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4543 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4544 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4545 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4546 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4547 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4548 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4549 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4550 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4551 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4552 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4553 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004554 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004555 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4556 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4557
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004558 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4559 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4560 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4561 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4562 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4563 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4564
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004565 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4566 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4567 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4568 repeated.
4569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4571 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4572 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4573 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004574
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004575 Examples :
4576 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4577 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4578 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004579 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004580
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004581 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004582
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004583
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004584declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4585 Declares a capture slot.
4586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4587 no | yes | yes | no
4588 Arguments:
4589 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4590
4591 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4592 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4593 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4594 for use in the response.
4595
4596 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004597 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004598 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4599
4600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004601default-server [param*]
4602 Change default options for a server in a backend
4603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4604 yes | no | yes | yes
4605 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004606 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4607 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4608 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4609 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004610
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004611 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004612 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4613
4614 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617default_backend <backend>
4618 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | no
4621 Arguments :
4622 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4623
4624 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4625 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4626 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4627 will catch all undetermined requests.
4628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004629 Example :
4630
4631 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4632 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4633 default_backend dynamic
4634
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004635 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004637
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004638description <string>
4639 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 no | yes | yes | yes
4642 Arguments : string
4643
4644 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4645 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4646 it describes.
4647 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4648
4649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004650disabled
4651 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments : none
4655
4656 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4657 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4658 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4659 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4660 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4661 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4662 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4663
4664 See also : "enabled"
4665
4666
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004667dispatch <address>:<port>
4668 Set a default server address
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004672
4673 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4674 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4675 during start-up.
4676
4677 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4678 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4679 possible with normal servers.
4680
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004681 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004682 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4683 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4684 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4685 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4686
4687 See also : "server"
4688
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004689
4690dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4691 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | no | yes | yes
4694 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4695
4696 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004697 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004698 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4699 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004700 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004701 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703enabled
4704 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments : none
4708
4709 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4710 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4711
4712 See also : "disabled"
4713
4714
4715errorfile <code> <file>
4716 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4718 yes | yes | yes | yes
4719 Arguments :
4720 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004721 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004722 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723
4724 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004725 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004726 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004727 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4728 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004729
4730 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4731 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4732 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4733
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004734 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4735
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004736 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4737 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4738 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4739 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4740 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4741 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4742 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4743 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4744 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004746 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4747 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4748 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004749 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004750 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4751
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004752 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004753
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004754 Example :
4755 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004756 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004757 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4758 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004761errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4762 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4763 section.
4764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4765 yes | yes | yes | yes
4766 Arguments :
4767 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4768
4769 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004770 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004771 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4772 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004773
4774 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4775 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4776 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4777 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4778 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004779 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004780 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4781
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004782 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4783 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004784
4785 Example :
4786 errorfiles generic
4787 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4788
4789
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790errorloc <code> <url>
4791errorloc302 <code> <url>
4792 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795 Arguments :
4796 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004797 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004798 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004799
4800 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4801 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4802 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4803 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004804 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004805
4806 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4807 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4808 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4809
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004810 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4813 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4814 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4815 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004816 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004817 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4818 request.
4819
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004820 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821
4822
4823errorloc303 <code> <url>
4824 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | yes
4827 Arguments :
4828 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004829 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004830 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004831
4832 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4833 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4834 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4835 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004836 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004837
4838 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4839 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4840 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4841
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004842 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004844 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4845 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4846 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4847 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004848 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004849
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004850 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004851
4852
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004853email-alert from <emailaddr>
4854 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004855 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | yes
4858
4859 Arguments :
4860
4861 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4862
4863 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4864 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4865
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004866 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004867 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4868 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004869
4870
4871email-alert level <level>
4872 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4873 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | yes | yes | yes
4876
4877 Arguments :
4878
4879 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4880 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4881 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4882
4883 By default level is alert
4884
4885 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4886 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4887 for the proxy.
4888
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004889 Alerts are sent when :
4890
4891 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4892 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4893 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4894 is notice or lower
4895 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4896 and a health check status update occurs
4897
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004898 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4899 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004900 section 3.6 about mailers.
4901
4902
4903email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4904 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | yes | yes | yes
4907
4908 Arguments :
4909
4910 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4911
4912 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4913 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4914
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004915 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4916 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004917
4918
4919email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4920 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4921 mailers.
4922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 yes | yes | yes | yes
4924
4925 Arguments :
4926
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004927 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004928
4929 By default the systems hostname is used.
4930
4931 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4932 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4933 for the proxy.
4934
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004935 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4936 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004937
4938
4939email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004940 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004941 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4943 yes | yes | yes | yes
4944
4945 Arguments :
4946
4947 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4948
4949 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4950 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4951
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004952 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004953 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4954
4955
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004956force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4957 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004959 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004960
4961 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4962 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4963 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4964 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4965 marked down for maintenance operations.
4966
4967 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4968 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4969 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4970 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4971 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4972 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4973 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4974 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4975 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4976
4977 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4978 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4979 is used.
4980
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004981 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004982 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004983
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004984
4985filter <name> [param*]
4986 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 no | yes | yes | yes
4989 Arguments :
4990 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4991 referenced in section 9.
4992
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004993 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004994 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004995 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4996 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004997
4998 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4999 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5000
5001 Example:
5002 listen
5003 bind *:80
5004
5005 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5006 filter compression
5007 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5008
5009 compression algo gzip
5010 compression offload
5011
5012 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5013
5014 See also : section 9.
5015
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005017fullconn <conns>
5018 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | no | yes | yes
5021 Arguments :
5022 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5023 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5024
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005025 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005027 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005028 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5029 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5030 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5031 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5032 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005033 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005034
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005035 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5036 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005037 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5038 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5039 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005041 Example :
5042 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5043 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5044 # connections.
5045 backend dynamic
5046 fullconn 10000
5047 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5048 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5049
5050 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5051
5052
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005053grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005054 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005056 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057 Arguments :
5058 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5059 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5060 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5061
5062 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5063 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005064 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005065 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5066
5067 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5068 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5069 simplify it.
5070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005071
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005072hash-balance-factor <factor>
5073 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | no | no | yes
5076 Arguments :
5077 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5078 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005079 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005080
5081 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5082 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5083 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5084 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5085 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5086 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5087 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5088
5089 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5090 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5091 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5092 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5093 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5094
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005095 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5096 consistent hashing mechanism.
5097
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005098 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5099
5100
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005101hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005102 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | no | yes | yes
5105 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005106 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5107 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005108
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005109 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5110 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5111 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5112 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5113 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5114 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5115 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5116 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5117 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5118 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005119
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005120 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5121 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5122 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5123 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5124 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5125 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5126 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5127 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5128 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5129 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5130 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5131 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5132 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005133 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5134 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005135
5136 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5137
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005138 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005139 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5140 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5141 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005142 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5143 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5144 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005145
5146 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5147 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005148 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5149 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5150 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5151 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5152
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005153 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5154 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5155 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5156 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5157 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5158 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5159 parameter.
5160
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005161 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5162 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5163 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5164 used on strings.
5165
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005166 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5167
5168 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5169 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5170 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5171 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5172 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5173 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5174 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5175 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5176 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5177 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5178 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5179 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005180
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005181 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5182 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5183 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005184
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005185 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005186
5187
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005188http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5189 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5190 ones).
5191
5192 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 no | yes | yes | yes
5194
5195 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5196 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5197 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5198 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5199 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5200 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5201
5202 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5203 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5204 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5205
5206 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5207 below.
5208
5209 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5210 instance.
5211
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005212 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5213 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5214 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5215
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005216 Example:
5217 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5218 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5219 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5220
5221http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5224 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5225 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5226 example, or to pass some internal information.
5227 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5228 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5229 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5230
5231http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5232
5233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5234 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5235
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005236http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005237
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005238 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5239 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5240 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5241 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5242 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005243
5244http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5245 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5246
5247 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5248
5249 Example:
5250 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5251
5252 # applied to:
5253 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5254
5255 # outputs:
5256 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5257
5258 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5259
5260http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5261 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5264
5265 Example:
5266 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5267
5268 # applied to:
5269 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5270
5271 # outputs:
5272 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5273
5274http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5275
5276 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5277 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5278 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5279
5280http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5281 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5282
5283 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5284 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5285 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5286 fallback.
5287
5288 Example:
5289 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5290 http-response set-status 431
5291 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5292 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5293
5294http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5295
5296 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5297 inline.
5298
5299 Arguments:
5300 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5301 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5305 (request and response)
5306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5307 processing
5308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5309 processing
5310 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5311 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5312 and '_'.
5313
5314 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5315 followed by some converters.
5316
5317 Example:
5318 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5319
5320http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5321
5322 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5323 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5324 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5325 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5326 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005327 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005328 processing.
5329
5330 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5331 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005332 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005333 rules evaluation.
5334
5335http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5336
5337 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5338 details about <var-name>.
5339
5340 Example:
5341 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5342
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005343
5344http-check comment <string>
5345 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5346 it fails.
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005350 Arguments :
5351 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5352 rule fails.
5353
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005354 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5355 user-friendly error reporting.
5356
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005357 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005358 "http-check expect".
5359
5360
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005361http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5362 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005363 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005364 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | no | yes | yes
5367
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005368 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005369 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5370
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005371 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005372 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005373
5374 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5375 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5376 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5377 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5378
5379 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5380
5381 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5382
5383 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5384
5385 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5386
5387 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5388
5389 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5390 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5391 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5392 is used.
5393
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005394 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5395 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5396 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5397 haproxy -vv.
5398
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005399 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5400
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005401 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5402 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5403 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5404 different ports or with different servers.
5405
5406 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5407 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5408 the port with a "http-check connect".
5409
5410 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5411 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5412 do.
5413
5414 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5415 unset-var or comment rules.
5416
5417 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005418 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5419 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5420 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5421 option httpchk
5422
5423 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005424 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005425 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005426 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005427 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005428 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005429
5430 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5431
5432 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005433
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005435http-check disable-on-404
5436 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005438 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005439 Arguments : none
5440
5441 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5442 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5443 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5444 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5445 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5446 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5447 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5448 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005449 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5450 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005451 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5452 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5453 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005456
5457
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005458http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5460 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5461 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005462 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005464 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005466 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005467 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5468
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5470 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5471 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5472 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5473 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5474 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5475 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5476 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5477 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5478 result is always conclusive.
5479
5480 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5481 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5482 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005483 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5484 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005485 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5486 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005487 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5488 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5489 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005490
5491 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5492 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005493 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5494 supported :
5495 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5496 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005497 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5498 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5499 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5500 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5501 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005502
5503 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5504 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005505 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5506 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5507 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5508 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5510
5511 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5512 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5513 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5514 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5515
5516 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5517 informational message reported in logs if an error
5518 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5519 log-format string.
5520
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005521 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005522 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5523 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005524 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5525 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5526 details on the supported keywords.
5527
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005528 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5529 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5530 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5531 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532
5533 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5534 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5535 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5536 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5537 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5538
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005539 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5540 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5541 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5542 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5543 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5544 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5545 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005546
5547 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005548 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005549 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5550 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5551 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5552 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5553
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005554 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5555 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005556 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5557 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5558 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5559 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5560 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5561 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5562 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5563 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005564 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5565 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5566 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5567 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5568 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5569 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5570 insensitive on the header names.
5571
5572 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5573 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5574 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5575 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5576 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5577 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005578
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005579 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5582 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5583 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5584 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5585 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005586 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587 trace).
5588
5589 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005590 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005591 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5592 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5593 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5594 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5595 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005596 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005598 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5599 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5600 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5601 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5602 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5603 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5604
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005605 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005606 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005607 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5608 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5609 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5610 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5611 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5612 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5613
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005614 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5615 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5616 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5617 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5618 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005619
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5621 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5622
5623 Examples :
5624 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005625 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005627 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5628 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5629
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005630 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005631 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005632
5633 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005634 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005635
5636 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005637 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005638
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005639 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005640 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005641
5642
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005643http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005644 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5645 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005646 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5647 health checks.
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5649 yes | no | yes | yes
5650 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005651 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5652
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005653 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5654 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5655 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5656 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5657 to invent non-standard ones.
5658
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005659 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5660 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5661 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5662 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5663
5664 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5665 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5666 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5667 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005668
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005669 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005670 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005671 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5673 to add it.
5674
5675 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5676 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5677 to the log-format rules.
5678
5679 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5680 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5681 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005682
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005683 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5684 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5685 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5686 request.
5687
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005688 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5689 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5690 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005691 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5692 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5693 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5694 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005695 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005696
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005697 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005698 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5699 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005700
5701 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5702 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5703 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5704 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5705 configured request authority.
5706
5707 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5708 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005709
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005710 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005711
5712
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005713http-check send-state
5714 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5716 yes | no | yes | yes
5717 Arguments : none
5718
5719 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5720 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5721 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5722 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5723 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5724
5725 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5726 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5727 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5728 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5729 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005730 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5731 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5732 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5733
5734 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5735 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5736 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5737
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005738 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5739 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5740 checked in multiple backends.
5741
5742 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5743 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5744
5745 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5746 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5747 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5748 one fails.
5749
5750 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5751 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5752 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5753
5754 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5755 server's queue.
5756
5757 Example of a header received by the application server :
5758 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5759 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5760
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005761 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5762 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005763
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764
5765http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | no | yes | yes
5769
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005770 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005771 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5772 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5773 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5774 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5775 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5776 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5777 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5778 and '-'.
5779
5780 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5781
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005782 Examples :
5783 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005784
5785
5786http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005787 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | no | yes | yes
5790
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005791 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5793 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5794 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5795 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5796 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5797 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5798 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5799 and '-'.
5800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005801 Examples :
5802 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005804
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005805http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5806 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5807 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5808 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5809 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5811 yes | yes | yes | yes
5812 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005813 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005814 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005815 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005816 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005817
5818 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5819 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5820 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5821 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5822
5823 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5824 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5825 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5826 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5827
5828 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5829 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5830 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5831 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5832 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5833 chroot is performed.
5834
5835 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5836 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5837 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5838 considered.
5839
5840 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5841 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5842 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5843 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5844 considered as a raw string.
5845
5846 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5847 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5848 "content-type".
5849
5850 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5851 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5852 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5853 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5854 evaluated as a log-format string.
5855
5856 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5857 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5858 argument to "content-type".
5859
5860 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5861 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5862 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5863 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5864
5865 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5866 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5867 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5868 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5869 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5870 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5871 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5872 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5873
5874 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5875 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5876 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5877
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005878 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5879 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5880 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5881 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5882 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5883
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005884 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5885 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5886
5887
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005888http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005889 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5890
5891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 no | yes | yes | yes
5893
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005894 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5895 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5896 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5897 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5898 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005900 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5901 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 Example:
5906 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5907 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5908 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005910 http-request allow if nagios
5911 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5912 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5913 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915 Example:
5916 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5917 acl add path /addacl
5918 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5923 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925 Example:
5926 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5927 acl setmap path /setmap
5928 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005931
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005932 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5933 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5936 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5941 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5942 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5943 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5944 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5945 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5946 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5947 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005949http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5952 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5953 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5954 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5955 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5956 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5957 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5958 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5963 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005964
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005966http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005968 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5969 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5970 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5971 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5972 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005973
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005974 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5975 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5976 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5977 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5978 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5979 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5980 instead.
5981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982 Example:
5983 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5984 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005985
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005986http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005987
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005988 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005989
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005990http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5991 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5994 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5995 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5996 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5997 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5998 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5999 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6000 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6001 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6004 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6005 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006006 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6007
6008 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6009 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6010 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6011 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006015 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6016 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6017 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6018 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6019 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6020 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006021
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006022http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006023
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006024 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6025 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6026 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6027 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6028 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6033 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6034 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6035 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6036 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6037 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006038
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006039http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6040http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6041 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6042 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6043 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6044 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006045
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006046 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6047 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6048 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006049 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006050 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6051 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6052 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006054 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006055
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006056http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6057 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6058 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6059 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6060
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006061http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6062
6063 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6064 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6065 pointed by <resolvers>.
6066 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6067 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6068 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6069 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6070 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6071 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6072 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6073 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6074 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6075 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6076 to 0.0.0.0.
6077
6078 Example:
6079 resolvers mydns
6080 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6081 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6082 timeout retry 1s
6083 hold valid 10s
6084 hold nx 3s
6085 hold other 3s
6086 hold obsolete 0s
6087 accepted_payload_size 8192
6088
6089 frontend fe
6090 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6091 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6092 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6093
6094 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6095 # which mean DNS resolution error
6096 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6097
6098 default_backend be
6099
6100 backend b_503
6101 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6102 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6103 # 503 error page to end users
6104
6105 backend be
6106 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6107 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6108 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6109 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6110 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6111
6112 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6113 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6114
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006115http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6116
6117 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6118 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6119 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6120 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006121 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6122 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006123
6124 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6125
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006126http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006127http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006128http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006129http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006130http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006131http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6132http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006133
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006134 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6135
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006136 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6137 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6138 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6139 processing in your infrastructure.
6140
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006141 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6142 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6143 the supported backend.
6144
6145 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6146 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6147 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6148 number of segments in the path.
6149
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006150 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6151 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6152 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6153 when improperly combined.
6154
6155 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6156 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6157 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6158 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6159 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6160
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006161 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006162
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006163 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6164 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006165
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006166 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6167 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6168
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006169 Example:
6170 - /. -> /
6171 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6172 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6173 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006174
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006175 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6176 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6177
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006178 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006179 their preceding segment.
6180
6181 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6182 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6183
6184 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6185 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006186
6187 Example:
6188 - /foo/../ -> /
6189 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6190 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6191 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006192 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006193 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006194 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006195
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006196 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6197 removed as well:
6198
6199 Example:
6200 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6201 - /bar/../../ -> /
6202
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006203 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6204 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006205
6206 Example:
6207 - // -> /
6208 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6209
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006210 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6211 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6212
6213 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6214 ".", "_", and "~".
6215
6216 Example:
6217 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6218 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6219 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6220 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6221
6222 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6223 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6224
6225 Example:
6226 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6227 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6228
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006229 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006230 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006231
6232 Example:
6233 - /%6f -> /%6F
6234 - /%zz -> /%zz
6235
6236 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6237 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6238
6239 Example:
6240 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6241
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006242 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006243 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6244 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6245
6246 Example:
6247 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6248 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6249 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006251http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006253 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6254 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6255 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6256 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6257 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006259http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006261 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6262 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6263 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6264 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006266http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6267 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006268
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006269 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006270 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6271 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6272 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6273 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6274 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006275
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006276 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6277 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6278 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6279 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6280 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006281
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006282 Example:
6283 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6284
6285 # applied to:
6286 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6287
6288 # outputs:
6289 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6290
6291 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006292
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006293 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6294
6295 # applied to:
6296 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006297
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006298 # outputs:
6299 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006300
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006301http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6302 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6303
6304 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6305 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006306 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6307 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6308 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006309
6310 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6311 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6312 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6313
6314 Example:
6315 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6316 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6317
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006318 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6319 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6320 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6321 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6322
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006323http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6325
6326 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6327 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6328 query-string are replaced.
6329
6330 Example:
6331 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6332 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6333
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006334http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6336
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006337 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6338 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6339 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6340 against.
6341
6342 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6343 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6344 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006345
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006346 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6347 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6348 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6349 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6350 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6351 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6352 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6353 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6354 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006355 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6356 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006357
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006358 Example:
6359 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6360 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006361
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006362 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6363 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006365http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006367
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006368 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6369 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6370 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6371 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006372
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006373 Example:
6374 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006375
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006376 # applied to:
6377 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006378
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006379 # outputs:
6380 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006381
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006382http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6383 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6384 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006385 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6387
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006388 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006389 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6390 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006391 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006392 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006393 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006394 are followed to create the response :
6395
6396 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6397 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6398 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6399 ignored.
6400
6401 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6402 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006403 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006404 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6405 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006406
6407 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6408 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6409 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006410 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6411 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006412
6413 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6414 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6415 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006416 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006417 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006418 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006419
6420 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6421 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6422 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6423 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6424 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6425 as a raw content.
6426
6427 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6428 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6429 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6430 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6431 considered as a raw string.
6432
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006433 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006434 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6435 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6436 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6437
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006438 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6439 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006440 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006441
6442 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6443
6444 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006445 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006446 if { path /ping }
6447
6448 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6449 if { path /favicon.ico }
6450
6451 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6452 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6453 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006455http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6456http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006458 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6459 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6460 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006461
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006462http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006464
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006465 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6466 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6467 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6468 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006470http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006472 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6473 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6474 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6475 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6476 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478 Arguments:
6479 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6480 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006482 Example:
6483 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6484 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6487 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006491 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6492 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6493 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495 Arguments:
6496 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6497 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006499 Example:
6500 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6501 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6504 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6505 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006509 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6510 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6511 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6512 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6513 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006515 Example:
6516 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6517 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6518 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6519 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6520 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6521 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6522 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6523 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6524 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006528 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6529 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6530 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6531 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6532 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6535 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6538 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6539 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6540 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6541 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6542 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6543 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6544 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6545 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006547http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006549 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6550 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6551 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6552 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6553 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6554 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6555 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006557http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006559 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6560 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6561 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006565 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6566 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6567 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6568 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6569 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6570 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6571 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6572 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006576 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6577 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6578 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6579 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6580 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6581 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 Example :
6584 # prepend the host name before the path
6585 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006586
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006587http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6588
6589 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6590 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6591 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006593http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6596 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6597 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6598 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6599 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6604 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6605 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6606 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6607 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6608 values have higher priority.
6609 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6610 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6611 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6612 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6613 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6618 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6619 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6620 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6621 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6622 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6623 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006626
6627 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6629 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6632 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6633 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6634 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006635 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6636 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637
6638 Arguments :
6639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6640 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006641
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006642 See also "option forwardfor".
6643
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006644 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6646 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6647
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006648 # After the masking this will track connections
6649 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6650 http-request track-sc0 src
6651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6653 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6654
6655http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6656
6657 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6658 expression.
6659
6660 Arguments:
6661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6662 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006663
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006664 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6666 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6667
6668 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6669 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6670 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6671
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006672http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006673 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6674
6675 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6676 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6677 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6678 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6679 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6680
6681 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6682 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6683 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6684 results.
6685
6686 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006687 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6688 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6691
6692 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6693 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6694 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6695 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6696 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6697 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6698 information from the request.
6699
6700 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6701
6702http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6703
6704 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6705 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6706 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6707 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6708 path and the query string.
6709 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6710
6711http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6712
6713 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6714 inline.
6715
6716 Arguments:
6717 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6718 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6719 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6720 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6721 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6722 (request and response)
6723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6724 processing
6725 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6726 processing
6727 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6728 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6729 and '_'.
6730
6731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6732 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006733
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006734 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006735 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6738 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6741 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6742 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6743 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6744 agent name must be used.
6745
6746 Arguments:
6747 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6748
6749 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6750 configuration.
6751
6752http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6753
6754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6755 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6756 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6757 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6758 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6759 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6760 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6761 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6762 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6763 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6764 action.
6765 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6766 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6767 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6768 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6769 you fully understand how it works.
6770
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006771http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6772
6773 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6774 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6775 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6776 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6777 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006778 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006779 processing.
6780
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006781 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006782 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6783 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6784 rules evaluation.
6785
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006786http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6787http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6788 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6789 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6790 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6791 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006792
6793 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6794 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6795 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006796 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6797 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6798 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6799 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6800 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6801 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6802 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6803 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6804 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6805 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006806 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006807 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6808 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6809 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6810 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6811 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812
6813http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6814http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6815http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6816
6817 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6818 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6819 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6820 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006821 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006822 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6823 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6824 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6825 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6826 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6827 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6828 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6829
6830 Arguments :
6831 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6832 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6833 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6834 select which table entry to update the counters.
6835
6836 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6837 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6838 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6839 that table until the session ends.
6840
6841 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6842 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6843 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6844 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6845 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6846 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6847 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6848 useful information.
6849
6850 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6851 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6852 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6853 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6854 checks that make use of it.
6855
6856http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857
6858 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006859
6860 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006861 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006862
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006863http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6864
6865 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6866 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6867 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6868 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6869 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6870 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6871
6872 Arguments :
6873 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6874
6875 Example:
6876 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6877
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006878http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6880
6881 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6882 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6883 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6884 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6885 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6886 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6887 http-buffer-request".
6888
6889 Arguments :
6890
6891 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6892 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6893
6894 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006895 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006896 bytes.
6897
6898 Example:
6899 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6900
6901 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006903http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006905 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6906 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6907 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006908
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006910http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006911 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6912
6913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 no | yes | yes | yes
6915
6916 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6917 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6918 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6919 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6920 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6921 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006923 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6924 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006926 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006928 Example:
6929 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006931 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006933 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6934 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006936 Example:
6937 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006939 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6942 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6945 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6950 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6951 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6952 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6953 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6954 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6955 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6956 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6961 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6962 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6963 example, or to pass some internal information.
6964 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6965 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6966 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6971 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006972
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006973http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006974
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006975 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006977http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6980 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6981 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6982 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6983 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6984 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6985 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006987 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6988 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6989 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6990 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6991 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006992
6993 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6994 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6995 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6996 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007000 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7001 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7002 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7003 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7004 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7005 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007006
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007007http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007008
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007009 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7010 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7011 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7012 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7013 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007015http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007017 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7018 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7019 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7020 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7021 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7022 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007023
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007024http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7025http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7026 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7027 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7028 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7029 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007030
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007031 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7032 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7033 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007034 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007035 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7036 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7037 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007038 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007039 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7044 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7045 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7046 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7047 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7048 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007052
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007053 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7054 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 Example:
7057 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 # applied to:
7060 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007062 # outputs:
7063 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7068 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007069
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007070 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007071 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 Example:
7074 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076 # applied to:
7077 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079 # outputs:
7080 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007081
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007082http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7083 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7084 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007085 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7087
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007089 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7090 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007091 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007092 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007093 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007094 are followed to create the response :
7095
7096 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7097 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7098 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7099 ignored.
7100
7101 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7102 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007103 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007104 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7105 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007106
7107 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7108 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7109 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007110 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7111 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007112
7113 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7114 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7115 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007116 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007117 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007118 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007119
7120 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7121 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7122 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7123 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7124 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7125 as a raw content.
7126
7127 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7128 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7129 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7130 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7131 considered as a raw string.
7132
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007133 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7134 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7135 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7136 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7137
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007138 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7139 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007140 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007141
7142 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7143
7144 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007145 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007146 if { status eq 404 }
7147
7148 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7149 string "This is the end !" \
7150 if { status eq 500 }
7151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007152http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7153http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007155 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7156 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7157 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007158
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007159http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007161
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007162 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7163 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7164 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7165 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007169 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7170 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7171 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7172 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7173 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007175 Arguments:
7176 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7179 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007183 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7184 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7185 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007187http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7188
7189 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7190 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7191 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7192 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7193 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7194
7195http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7196
7197 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7198 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7199 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7200 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7201 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7202 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7203 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7204 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7205 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7206
7207http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7208
7209 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7210 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7211 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7212 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7213 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7214 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7215 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7216
7217http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7218
7219 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7220 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7221 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7222 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7223 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7224 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7225 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7226 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7227
7228http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7230
7231 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7232 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7233 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7234 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007235
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007236 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7238 http-response set-status 431
7239 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7240 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007242http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007244 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7245 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7246 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7247 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7248 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7249 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7250 based on some information from the request.
7251
7252 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7253
7254http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7255
7256 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7257 inline.
7258
7259 Arguments:
7260 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7261 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7265 (request and response)
7266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7267 processing
7268 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7269 processing
7270 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7271 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7272 and '_'.
7273
7274 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7275 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007276
7277 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007278 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7283 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7284 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7285 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7286 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7287 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7288 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7289 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7290 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7291 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7292 action.
7293 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7294 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7295 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7296 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7297 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007298
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007299http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7300
7301 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7302 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7303 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7304 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7305 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007306 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007307 processing.
7308
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007309 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007310 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007311 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007312 rules evaluation.
7313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007314http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7315http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7316http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007318 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7319 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7320 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7321 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7322 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7323 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7324
7325http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7326
7327 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7328 about <var-name>.
7329
7330 Example:
7331 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7332
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007333http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7335
7336 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7337 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7338 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7339 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7340 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7341 buffer is full.
7342
7343 Arguments :
7344
7345 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7346 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7347
7348 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007349 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007350 bytes.
7351
7352 Example:
7353 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007354
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007355http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7356 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7357
7358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | no | yes | yes
7360
7361 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007362 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7363 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7364 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007365
7366 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7367
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007368 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7369 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7370 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7371 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7372 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7373 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7374 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7375 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7376 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7377 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007378
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007379 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7380 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7381 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7382 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7383 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7384 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7385 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007386 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7387 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7388 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7389 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7390 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7391 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007392
7393 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7394 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7395 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7396 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7397 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7398 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7399 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7400 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007401 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007402 downsides of rare connection failures.
7403
7404 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7405 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7406 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7407 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7408 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7409 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007410 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007411 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7412 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7413 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7414 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7415 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7416
7417 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007418 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7419 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7420 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7421 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007422
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007423 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7424 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007425
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007426 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007427
7428 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7429 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7430 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7431
7432 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7433
7434
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007435http-send-name-header [<header>]
7436 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007439 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007440 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7441
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007442 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7443 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7444 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7445 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7446 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7447 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7448 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7449 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7450 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7451 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7452 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7453 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7454 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7455 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7456 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7457 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007458
7459 See also : "server"
7460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007461id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007462 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 no | yes | yes | yes
7465 Arguments : none
7466
7467 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7468 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7469 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007470
7471
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007472ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7473 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007475 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007476
7477 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7478 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7479 and running).
7480
7481 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7482 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7483 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007484 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007485 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7486
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007487 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7488 "unless" condition is met.
7489
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007490 Example:
7491 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7492 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7493 ignore-persist if url_static
7494
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007495 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7496
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007497load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7498 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7500 yes | no | yes | yes
7501
7502 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7503 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7504 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007505 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007506 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7507 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7508 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7509 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007511 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007512 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007513 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007514
7515 Arguments:
7516 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7517 named "server-state-file".
7518
7519 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7520 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7521 name is used as a file name.
7522
7523 none don't load any stat for this backend
7524
7525 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007526 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7527 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7528 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007530 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007531
7532 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7533 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007535 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007537 global
7538 stats socket /tmp/socket
7539 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007540
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007541 defaults
7542 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007543
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007544 backend bk
7545 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7546 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007547
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007548
7549 Then one can run :
7550
7551 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7552
7553 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7554
7555 1
7556 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7557 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7558 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7559
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007560 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007561
7562 global
7563 stats socket /tmp/socket
7564 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7565
7566 defaults
7567 load-server-state-from-file local
7568
7569 backend bk
7570 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7571 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7572
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007573
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007574 Then one can run :
7575
7576 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7577
7578 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7579
7580 1
7581 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7582 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7583 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7584
7585 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7586 "show servers state"
7587
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007588
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007589log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007590log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007591 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007592no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007593 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7595 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007596
7597 Prefix :
7598 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7599 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7600 prefix does not allow arguments.
7601
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007602 Arguments :
7603 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7604 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7605 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7606 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7607 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7608 parameter.
7609
7610 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7611 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7612
7613 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7614 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7615 standard syslog port).
7616
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007617 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7618 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7619 standard syslog port).
7620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007621 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7622 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7623 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007624 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007625
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007626 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7627 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7628 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7629 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7630 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7631 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7632 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7633 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7634 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7635 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7636 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7637 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7638 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7639 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7640 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7641 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007642 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7643 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007644
7645 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7646 and "fd@2", see above.
7647
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007648 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7649 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7650 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7651 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7652 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7653 having the logs instantly available.
7654
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007655 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7656 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7657 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7658
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007659 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7660 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007661
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007662 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7663 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7664 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7665 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7666 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7667 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7668 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7669 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7670 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7671 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007673
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007674 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7675 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7676 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7677 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7678 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7679
7680 <sample_size>
7681 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7682 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7683 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7684 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7685 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7686
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007687 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7688 one of the following :
7689
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007690 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7691 field is stripped. This is the default.
7692 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7693 rfc3164.
7694
7695 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007696 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7697
7698 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7699 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7700
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007701 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7702 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7703 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7704 designed to be used with a local log server.
7705
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007706 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7707 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7708 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7709 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7710 systemd logger consumes.
7711
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007712 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7713 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7714 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7715 used with a local log server.
7716
7717 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7718 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7719 designed to be used with a local log server.
7720
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007721 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7722 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7723 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7724 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007726 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7727
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007728 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7729 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7730 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7731
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007732 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7733 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7734 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7735 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007736
7737 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7738 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7739 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007740 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7741 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7742 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7743 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7744 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007745
7746 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7747
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007748 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7749 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7750 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007751
7752 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7753 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7754 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7755 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7756
7757 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7758 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007759
7760 Example :
7761 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007762 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7763 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7764 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007765 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007766 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7767 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007768 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007769
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007770
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007771log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007772 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007775
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007776 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7777 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7778 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7779 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7780 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007781
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007782 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7783 "option httplog" directives.
7784
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007785log-format-sd <string>
7786 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7788 yes | yes | yes | no
7789
7790 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7791 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7792 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7793 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7794 which covers the log format string in depth.
7795
7796 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7797 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7798
7799 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7800 log format to "rfc5424".
7801
7802 Example :
7803 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7804
7805
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007806log-tag <string>
7807 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7809 yes | yes | yes | yes
7810
7811 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7812 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7813 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7814 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7815 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7816 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7817 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7818 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7819 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007820
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007821max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7822 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | no | yes | yes
7825
7826 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7827 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7828 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7829 servers.
7830
7831 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7832 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7833 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7834 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7835 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007836 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007837 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7838 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7839 picking a different server.
7840
7841 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7842 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7843 even if they have to be queued.
7844
7845 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7846 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7847
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007848max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7849 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7850 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7851 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007853maxconn <conns>
7854 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 yes | yes | yes | no
7857 Arguments :
7858 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7859 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7860 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7861 closes.
7862
7863 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7864 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7865 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7866 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007867 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7868 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7869 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7870 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007871
7872 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7873 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7874 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7875
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007876 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7877 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007879 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7880
7881
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007882mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007883 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 yes | yes | yes | yes
7886 Arguments :
7887 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7888 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7889 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7890 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7891
7892 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7893 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7894 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7895 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7896 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7897
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007898 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7899 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7900 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007902 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007903 defaults http_instances
7904 mode http
7905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007906
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007907monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007908 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007911 Arguments :
7912 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7913 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007914 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007915 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7916 backend and its backup.
7917
7918 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7919 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7920 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7921 servers in a list of backends.
7922
7923 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7924 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7925 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7926 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7927 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7928 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7929 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007930 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7931 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007932
7933 Example:
7934 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007935 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007936 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7937 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7938 monitor-uri /site_alive
7939 monitor fail if site_dead
7940
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007941 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007942
7943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007944monitor-uri <uri>
7945 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7947 yes | yes | yes | no
7948 Arguments :
7949 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7950 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7951
7952 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7953 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7954 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7955 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7956 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7957 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7958 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7959 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7960
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007961 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007962 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7963 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7964 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7965 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7966 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7967 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007968
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007969 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7970 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7971 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7972 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007974 Example :
7975 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7976 frontend www
7977 mode http
7978 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7979
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007980 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007983option abortonclose
7984no option abortonclose
7985 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 yes | no | yes | yes
7988 Arguments : none
7989
7990 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7991 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7992 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7993 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007994 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007995 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7996 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7997 encountered while delivering the response.
7998
7999 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8000 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8001 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8002 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8003 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8004 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008005 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008006 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008007 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008008 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8009 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8010 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8011
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008012 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8013 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008014 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8015 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8016 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8017 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8018 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8019 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008020 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008021
8022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8024
8025 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8026
8027
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008028option accept-invalid-http-request
8029no option accept-invalid-http-request
8030 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | yes | yes | no
8033 Arguments : none
8034
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008035 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008036 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008037 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008038 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8039 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8040 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8041 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8042 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008043 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8044 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8045 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8046 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008048 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008049 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8050 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8051 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008052
8053 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8054 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8055 been confirmed.
8056
8057 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8058 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008059 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8060 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008061 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8062
8063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8065
8066 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8067 stats socket.
8068
8069
8070option accept-invalid-http-response
8071no option accept-invalid-http-response
8072 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 yes | no | yes | yes
8075 Arguments : none
8076
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008077 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008078 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008079 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008080 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8081 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8082 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8083 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8084 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008085 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8086 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8087 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008088
8089 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8090 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8091 been confirmed.
8092
8093 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8094 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8095 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8096 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8097
8098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8100
8101 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8102 stats socket.
8103
8104
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008105option allbackups
8106no option allbackups
8107 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | no | yes | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
8112 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8113 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8114 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8115 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8116 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8117 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8118 order between the backup servers anymore.
8119
8120 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8121 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8122
8123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8125
8126
8127option checkcache
8128no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008129 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8131 yes | no | yes | yes
8132 Arguments : none
8133
8134 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8135 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008136 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008137 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8138 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008139 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008140
8141 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008142 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008143 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008144 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8145 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008146 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008147 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008148 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8149 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008150 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008151 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8152 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008153 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008154 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8155 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8156 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8157 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8158 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8159 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8160 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8161 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8162 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8163
8164 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008165 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8166 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8167 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8168 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008169
8170 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8171 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008172 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008173 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008174
8175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8177
8178
8179option clitcpka
8180no option clitcpka
8181 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 yes | yes | yes | no
8184 Arguments : none
8185
8186 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8187 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008189 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8190
8191 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8192 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8193 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8194 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8195
8196 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8197 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8198 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8199 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8200 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8201
8202 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8203
8204 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8205 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8206 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8207
8208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8210
8211 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8212
8213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008214option contstats
8215 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | yes | yes | no
8218 Arguments : none
8219
8220 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8221 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8222 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8223 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008224 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8225 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8226 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8227 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8228 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008229
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008230option disable-h2-upgrade
8231no option disable-h2-upgrade
8232 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8233 connection.
8234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8235 yes | yes | yes | no
8236 Arguments : none
8237
8238 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8239 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8240 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8241 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008242 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8243 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8244 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8245 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8246 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8247 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008248
8249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008251
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008252option dontlog-normal
8253no option dontlog-normal
8254 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8256 yes | yes | yes | no
8257 Arguments : none
8258
8259 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8260 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8261 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8262 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8263 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8264 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8265 logged.
8266
8267 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8268 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8269 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008271 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008272 logging.
8273
8274
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275option dontlognull
8276no option dontlognull
8277 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8279 yes | yes | yes | no
8280 Arguments : none
8281
8282 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8283 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8284 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8285 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8286 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8287 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008288 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8289 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8290 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008291
8292 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008293 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008294 would not be logged.
8295
8296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8298
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008299 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008300 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008301
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008302
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008303option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008304 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | yes | yes | yes
8307 Arguments :
8308 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8309 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008310 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008311 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008312
8313 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8314 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8315 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8316 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8317 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8318 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8319 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008320 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8321 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8322 possible that the client has already brought one.
8323
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008324 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008325 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008327 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008328 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008329 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008330
8331 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8332 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8333 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8334 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8335 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8336 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008337 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008338
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008339 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8340 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8341 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8342 are under the control of the end-user.
8343
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008344 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008345 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8346 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008347 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8348 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8349 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008350
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008351 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008352 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8353 frontend www
8354 mode http
8355 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8356
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008357 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8358 backend www
8359 mode http
8360 option forwardfor header X-Client
8361
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008362 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008363 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008364
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008365
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008366option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8367no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8368 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8370 yes | yes | yes | no
8371 Arguments : none
8372
8373 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8374 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8375 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8376 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8377 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8378 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8379 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8380
8381 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8382 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8383 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8384 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8385 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8386 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8387 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8388 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8389 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8390 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8391
8392 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8393
8394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8396
8397 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8398 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8399
8400
8401option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8402no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8403 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8405 yes | no | yes | yes
8406 Arguments : none
8407
8408 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8409 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8410 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8411 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8412 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8413 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8414 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8415
8416 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8417 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8418 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8419 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8420 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8421 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8422 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8423 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8424 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8425 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8426
8427 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8428
8429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8431
8432 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8433 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8434
8435
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008436option http-buffer-request
8437no option http-buffer-request
8438 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | yes
8441 Arguments : none
8442
8443 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8444 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8445 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8446 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8447 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8448 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008449 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8450 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8451 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8452 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008453
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008454 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8455 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008456
8457
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008458option http-ignore-probes
8459no option http-ignore-probes
8460 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8462 yes | yes | yes | no
8463 Arguments : none
8464
8465 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8466 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8467 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8468 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8469 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8470 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8471 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8472 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8473 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008474 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8475 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008476 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8477
8478 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8479 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8480 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8481 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8482 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8483 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8484 are often the only way to detect them.
8485
8486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8488
8489 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8490
8491
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008492option http-keep-alive
8493no option http-keep-alive
8494 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8496 yes | yes | yes | yes
8497 Arguments : none
8498
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008499 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8500 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008501 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8502 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008503 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8504 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8505 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008506
8507 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8508 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008509 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8510 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8511 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8512 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8513 situations where this option may be useful :
8514
8515 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008516 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008517
8518 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8519 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8520
8521 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8522 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8523 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8524 request.
8525
8526 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8527 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008528 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8529 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8530 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008531
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008532 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8533 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8534 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8535 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8536 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8537 not set.
8538
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008539 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8540 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8541 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008542
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008543 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008544 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008545 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008546
8547
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008548option http-no-delay
8549no option http-no-delay
8550 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | yes | yes | yes
8553 Arguments : none
8554
8555 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8556 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8557 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8558 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8559 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8560 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8561 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8562 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8563 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8564 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8565 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8566 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8567 affected.
8568
8569 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8570 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8571 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8572 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8573 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8574 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8575 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8576 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8577 latency environments.
8578
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008579 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8580
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008581
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008582option http-pretend-keepalive
8583no option http-pretend-keepalive
8584 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008586 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008587 Arguments : none
8588
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008589 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008590 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8591 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8592 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8593 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8594 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8595 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8596 consider the response complete.
8597
8598 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8599 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8600 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8601 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008602 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008603 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8604
8605 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8606 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8607 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8608 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8609 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8610 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8611 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8612
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008613 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8614 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8615 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8616 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8617 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8618 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008619
8620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8622
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008623 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008624 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008625
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008626
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008627option http-server-close
8628no option http-server-close
8629 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8631 yes | yes | yes | yes
8632 Arguments : none
8633
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008634 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8635 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8636 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8637 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008638 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8639 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8640 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8641 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8642 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8643 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8644 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8645 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8646 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8647 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8648 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008649
8650 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8651 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8652 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8653 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008654 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8655 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008656
8657 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8658 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008659 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8660 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8661 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008662
8663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8665
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008666 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8667 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008668
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008669option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008670no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008671 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 yes | yes | yes | no
8674 Arguments : none
8675
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008676 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008677 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8678 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8679 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8680 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8681 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8682 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8683
8684 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8685 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008686 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8687 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8688 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008689
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008690 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8691 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8692 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8693 front of an existing proxy.
8694
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008695 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8696
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008697 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008699option httpchk
8700option httpchk <uri>
8701option httpchk <method> <uri>
8702option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008703 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8705 yes | no | yes | yes
8706 Arguments :
8707 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8708 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8709 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8710 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8711 ones.
8712
8713 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8714 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8715 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8716
8717 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8718 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8719 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008720 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008721
8722 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8723 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8724 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8725 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8726 the lack of any response.
8727
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008728 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8729 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8730 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8731 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8732
8733 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8734 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8735 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008736
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008737 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8738 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008739 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008740 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008741 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008742
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008743 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8744 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8745 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8746 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008748 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008749 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8750 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8751 backend https_relay
8752 mode tcp
8753 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8754 http-check send hdr Host www
8755 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008757 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8758 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8759 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008760
8761
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008762option httpclose
8763no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008764 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 yes | yes | yes | yes
8767 Arguments : none
8768
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008769 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8770 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8771 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8772 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008773 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008775 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8776 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008777 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008778 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8779 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008780
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008781 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8782 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8783 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008784
8785 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8786 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008787 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8788 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8789 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008790
8791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8793
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008794 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008795
8796
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008797option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008798 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008800 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008801 Arguments :
8802 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8803 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8804 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008806 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008807
8808 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8809 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8810 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8811 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8812 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8813 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8814 ports.
8815
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008816 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8817 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008818
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008819 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008821 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008822
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008823
8824option http_proxy
8825no option http_proxy
8826 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8828 yes | yes | yes | yes
8829 Arguments : none
8830
8831 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8832 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8833 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8834 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8835 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8836
8837 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8838 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008839 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8840 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008841
8842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8844
8845 Example :
8846 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8847 backend direct_forward
8848 option httpclose
8849 option http_proxy
8850
8851 See also : "option httpclose"
8852
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008853
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008854option independent-streams
8855no option independent-streams
8856 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8858 yes | yes | yes | yes
8859 Arguments : none
8860
8861 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8862 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8863 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8864 receive data or not.
8865
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008866 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008867 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8868 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8869 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8870 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8871 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8872 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8873 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8874 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8875 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8876 socket buffers.
8877
8878 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8879 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8880 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8881 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8882 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8883
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008884 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008885
8886
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008887option ldap-check
8888 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8890 yes | no | yes | yes
8891 Arguments : none
8892
8893 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8894 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8895 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8896 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8897
8898 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8899 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8900
8901 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8902 configure it.
8903
8904 Example :
8905 option ldap-check
8906
8907 See also : "option httpchk"
8908
8909
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008910option external-check
8911 Use external processes for server health checks
8912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8913 yes | no | yes | yes
8914
8915 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8916 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8917 command".
8918
8919 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8920
8921 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8922
8923
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008924option log-health-checks
8925no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008926 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8928 yes | no | yes | yes
8929 Arguments : none
8930
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008931 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8932 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8933 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008934
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008935 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8936 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8937 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8938 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8939 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8940
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008941 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008942 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008943
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008944 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8945 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8946 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008947
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008948
8949option log-separate-errors
8950no option log-separate-errors
8951 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | yes | yes | no
8954 Arguments : none
8955
8956 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8957 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8958 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8959 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8960 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8961 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8962 provides very important information.
8963
8964 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8965 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8966 error logs.
8967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008969 logging.
8970
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008971
8972option logasap
8973no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008974 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8976 yes | yes | yes | no
8977 Arguments : none
8978
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008979 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8980 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8981 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8982 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8983
8984 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8985 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8986 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8987 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8988 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008989 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008990 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8991 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8992 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8993 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008994 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008996 Examples :
8997 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8998 mode http
8999 option httplog
9000 option logasap
9001 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9002
9003 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9004 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9005 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9006 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009008 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009009 logging.
9010
9011
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009012option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009013 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9015 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009016 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009017 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9018 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009019 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9020 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009021
9022 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9023 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009024 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009025 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9026 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9027 in the MySQL table, like this :
9028
9029 USE mysql;
9030 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9031 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9032
9033 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009034 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009035 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9036 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9037 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9038 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9039 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9040 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9041 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9042
9043 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9044 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009045
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009046 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009047
9048 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9049 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9050 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9051 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009052 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9053 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009054
9055 See also: "option httpchk"
9056
9057
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009058option nolinger
9059no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009060 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9062 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009063 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009064
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009066 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9067 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9068 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9069 connections.
9070
9071 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9072 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009073 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9074 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9075 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9076 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9077 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9078 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9079 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9080 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9081 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9082 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9083 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9084 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9085 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009086
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009087 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9088 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9089 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9090 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9091 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009092
9093 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9094 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009095 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009096 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009097 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009098
9099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9101
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009102 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9103 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009104
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009105option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9106 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9108 yes | yes | yes | yes
9109 Arguments :
9110 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9111 matching <network>
9112 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9113 header name.
9114
9115 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9116 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9117 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9118 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9119 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9120 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9121 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9122 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9123 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9124 possible that the client has already brought one.
9125
9126 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9127 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9128 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9129 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9130 header and requires different one.
9131
9132 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9133 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9134 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009135 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9136 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9137 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9138 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9139 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009140
9141 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9142 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9143 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9144 both are defined.
9145
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009146 Examples :
9147 # Original Destination address
9148 frontend www
9149 mode http
9150 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9151
9152 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9153 backend www
9154 mode http
9155 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9156
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009157 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009158
9159
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009160option persist
9161no option persist
9162 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9164 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009165 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009166
9167 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9168 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9169 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9170 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9171 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9172 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9173 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9174 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9175 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9176 redirected to another valid server.
9177
9178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9180
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009181 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009182
9183
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009184option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9185 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9187 yes | no | yes | yes
9188 Arguments :
9189 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9190 PostgreSQL server.
9191
9192 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9193 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9194 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9195 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9196
9197 See also: "option httpchk"
9198
9199
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009200option prefer-last-server
9201no option prefer-last-server
9202 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9204 yes | no | yes | yes
9205 Arguments : none
9206
9207 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9208 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9209 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9210 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9211 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9212 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9213 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9214 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9215 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009216 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9217 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009218 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9219 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9220 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009221 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9222 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9223 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009224
9225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9227
9228 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9229
9230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009231option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009232option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009233no option redispatch
9234 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009237 Arguments :
9238 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9239 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9240 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009241 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009242 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009243 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009244 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9245 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9246 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009248
9249 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9250 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9251 be able to access the service anymore.
9252
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009253 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9254 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009255
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009256 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9257 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9258 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9259 following order:
9260
9261 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9262
9263 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9264 list, or
9265
9266 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9267
9268 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9269 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9270
9271 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9272 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9273 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9274 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9275
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009276 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009277 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9278 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9282
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009283 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009284
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009285
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009286option redis-check
9287 Use redis health checks for server testing
9288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 yes | no | yes | yes
9290 Arguments : none
9291
9292 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9293 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9294 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9295 find the "+PONG" response message.
9296
9297 Example :
9298 option redis-check
9299
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009300 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009301
9302
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009303option smtpchk
9304option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9305 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009309 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009310 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009311 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9312
9313 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9314 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9315 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9316
9317 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9318 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9319 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9320 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9321 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9322 dead server.
9323
9324 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9325 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009327 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9328
9329 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9330 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9331 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9332 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009333 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009334
9335 Example :
9336 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9337
9338 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009341option socket-stats
9342no option socket-stats
9343
9344 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 yes | yes | yes | no
9347
9348 Arguments : none
9349
9350
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009351option splice-auto
9352no option splice-auto
9353 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | yes | yes | yes
9356 Arguments : none
9357
9358 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9359 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009361 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009362 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009363 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9364 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9365 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9366 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9367
9368 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9369 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9370 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9371 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9372 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9373 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9374 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9375 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9376 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9377 keyword.
9378
9379 Example :
9380 option splice-auto
9381
9382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9384
9385 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9386 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9387
9388
9389option splice-request
9390no option splice-request
9391 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 yes | yes | yes | yes
9394 Arguments : none
9395
9396 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009397 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009398 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9399 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9400 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9401 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9402
9403 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9404
9405 Example :
9406 option splice-request
9407
9408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9410
9411 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9412 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9413
9414
9415option splice-response
9416no option splice-response
9417 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9419 yes | yes | yes | yes
9420 Arguments : none
9421
9422 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009423 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009424 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9425 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9426 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9427 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9428
9429 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9430
9431 Example :
9432 option splice-response
9433
9434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9436
9437 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9438 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9439
9440
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009441option spop-check
9442 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9444 no | no | no | yes
9445 Arguments : none
9446
9447 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9448 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9449 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9450 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9451
9452 Example :
9453 option spop-check
9454
9455 See also : "option httpchk"
9456
9457
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009458option srvtcpka
9459no option srvtcpka
9460 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 yes | no | yes | yes
9463 Arguments : none
9464
9465 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9466 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009467 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009468 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9469
9470 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9471 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9472 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9473 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9474
9475 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9476 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9477 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9478 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9479 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9480
9481 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9482
9483 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9484 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9485 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9486
9487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9489
9490 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9491
9492
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009493option ssl-hello-chk
9494 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9496 yes | no | yes | yes
9497 Arguments : none
9498
9499 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9500 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9501 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9502 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9503 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9504 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9505 hello message.
9506
9507 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9508 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9509 messages, which is appreciable.
9510
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009511 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9512 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9513 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009515 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9516
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009517
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009518option tcp-check
9519 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9521 yes | no | yes | yes
9522
9523 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9524 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9525
9526 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9527 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9528 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009530 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009531 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9532 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9533 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9534 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9535 only.
9536
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009537 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009538 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9539 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9540 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9541 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9542
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009543 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009544 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9545 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009546 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009547 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9548 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9549 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9550 the respective protocols.
9551 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009552 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009553
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009554 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009555
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009556 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9557 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9558 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9559 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009560
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009561 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9562 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9563 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009564
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009565
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009566 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009568 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009569 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009570
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009571 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009573 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009574
9575 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9576 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009577 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009578 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009579 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009580 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009581 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009582 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009583 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9584 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009585 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009586 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9587 tcp-check expect string +OK
9588
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009589 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009590 (send many headers before analyzing)
9591 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009592 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009593 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9594 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9595 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9596 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009597 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009598
9599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009600 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601
9602
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009603option tcp-smart-accept
9604no option tcp-smart-accept
9605 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9607 yes | yes | yes | no
9608 Arguments : none
9609
9610 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9611 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9612 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9613 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9614 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9615 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9616
9617 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9618 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9619 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9620 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9621
9622 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9623 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9624 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009626
9627 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9628 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9629 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9630
9631 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9632 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9633 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9634
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009635 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9636
9637
9638option tcp-smart-connect
9639no option tcp-smart-connect
9640 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9642 yes | no | yes | yes
9643 Arguments : none
9644
9645 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9646 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9647 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9648 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9649 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9650
9651 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9652 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9653 complex.
9654
9655 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9656 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9657 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9658
9659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9661
9662 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9663
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009664
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009665option tcpka
9666 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9668 yes | yes | yes | yes
9669 Arguments : none
9670
9671 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9672 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009674 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9675
9676 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9677 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9678 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9679 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9680
9681 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9682 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9683 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9684 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9685 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9686
9687 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9688
9689 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9690 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9691 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9692 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9693 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9694 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9695 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9696 backends.
9697
9698 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9699
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009700
9701option tcplog
9702 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009704 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009705 Arguments : none
9706
9707 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9708 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9709 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9710 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9711 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9712 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9713 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9714 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9715
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009716 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009718 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009719
9720
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009721option transparent
9722no option transparent
9723 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009726 Arguments : none
9727
9728 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9729 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9730 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9731 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9732 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9733 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9734 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9735 appropriate server.
9736
9737 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9738 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9739
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009740 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009741 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009742
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009743
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009744external-check command <command>
9745 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9747 yes | no | yes | yes
9748
9749 Arguments :
9750 <command> is the external command to run
9751
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009752 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9753
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009754 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009755
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009756 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9757 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9758 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9759 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9760 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9761 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009762
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009763 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9764
9765 Environment variables :
9766 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9767 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9768
9769 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9770
9771 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9772
9773 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9774 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9775 for a UNIX socket).
9776
9777 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9778
9779 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9780
9781 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9782
9783 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9784
9785 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9786
9787 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9788 socket).
9789
9790 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9791 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9792
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009793 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9794
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009795 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9796 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9797 failed.
9798
9799 Example :
9800 external-check command /bin/true
9801
9802 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9803
9804
9805external-check path <path>
9806 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 yes | no | yes | yes
9809
9810 Arguments :
9811 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9812
9813 The default path is "".
9814
9815 Example :
9816 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9817
9818 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9819 "external-check command"
9820
9821
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009822persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009823persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009824 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9826 yes | no | yes | yes
9827 Arguments :
9828 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009829 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9830 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009831
9832 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9833 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009834 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009835 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9836 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9837 forwarded to this server.
9838
9839 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9840 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9841 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009842 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009843 a single "listen" section.
9844
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009845 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9846 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9847 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9848
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009849 Example :
9850 listen tse-farm
9851 bind :3389
9852 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9853 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9854 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9855 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9856 persist rdp-cookie
9857 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009858 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009859 balance rdp-cookie
9860 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9861 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9862
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009863 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9864 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009865
9866
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009867rate-limit sessions <rate>
9868 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9870 yes | yes | yes | no
9871 Arguments :
9872 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9873 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9874
9875 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9876 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9877 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9878 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9879 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9880 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9881
9882 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9883 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9884 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9885 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9886
9887 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9888 listen smtp
9889 mode tcp
9890 bind :25
9891 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009892 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009893
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009894 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9895 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9896 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009897
9898 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9899
9900
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009901redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9902redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9903redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009904 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9906 no | yes | yes | yes
9907
9908 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009909 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009910
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009911 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009912 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009913 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9914 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9915 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009916
9917 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9918 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9919 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9920 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9921 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009922 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9923 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9924 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9925 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009926
9927 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9928 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9929 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9930 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9931 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9932 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009933 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009934 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009935 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9936 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9937 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009938
9939 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009940 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9941 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9942 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009943 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009944 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9945 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9946 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9947 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009948
9949 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009950 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009951
9952 - "drop-query"
9953 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9954 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9955 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9956 with a location-type redirect.
9957
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009958 - "append-slash"
9959 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9960 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9961 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9962 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9963
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009964 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9965 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9966 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9967 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9968 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9969 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9970 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9971
9972 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9973 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9974 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9975 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9976 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9977 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9978 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009979
9980 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9981 acl clear dst_port 80
9982 acl secure dst_port 8080
9983 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009984 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009985 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009986 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9987
9988 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009989 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9990 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9991 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009993
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009994 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9995 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9996 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9997
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009998 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009999 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010000
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010001 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010002 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10003 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10004 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010007
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010008
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010009retries <value>
10010 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10012 yes | no | yes | yes
10013 Arguments :
10014 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10015 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10016 default value is 3.
10017
10018 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10019 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10020 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10021
10022 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010023 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10024 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010025
10026 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10027 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10028
10029 See also : "option redispatch"
10030
10031
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010032retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010033 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10034 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10035 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10037 yes | no | yes | yes
10038 Arguments :
10039 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10040 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10041 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10042 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10043
10044 none never retry
10045
10046 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10047 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10048
10049 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10050 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10051 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10052 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10053 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10054 processing the request.
10055
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010056 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10057 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10058 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10059 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10060 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10061 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10062 overflow attack for example).
10063
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010064 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10065 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10066 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10067 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10068 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10069 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10070 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10071 amplify denial of service attacks.
10072
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010073 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10074 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10075 considered to be safe to retry.
10076
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010077 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10078 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10079 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10080 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10081 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010082
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010083 all-retryable-errors
10084 retry request for any error that are considered
10085 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10086 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10087 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10088
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010089 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10090 not cumulative.
10091
10092 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10093 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10094 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10095 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10096
10097 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10098 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10099 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10100 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10101 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10102 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10103 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10104 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10105 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10106 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10107 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10108 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10109
10110 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10111 should not use this directive.
10112
10113 The default is "conn-failure".
10114
10115 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10116
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010117server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010118 Declare a server in a backend
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 no | no | yes | yes
10121 Arguments :
10122 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010123 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010124 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010125
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010126 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10127 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10128 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10129 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010130 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10131 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10132 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10133 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10134 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010135 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10136 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10137 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10138 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10139 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10140 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10141 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010142 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010143 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10144 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10145 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10146 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10147 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10148 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010149 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10150 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010151 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10152 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010154 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10156 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10157 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10158 adding this value to the client's port.
10159
10160 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10161 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010162 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010163
10164 Examples :
10165 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10166 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010167 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010168 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10169 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10170 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010171
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010172 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10173 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10174 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10175 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10176 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10177
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010178 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10179 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010180
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010181server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010182 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010183 this backend.
10184 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 no | no | yes | yes
10186
10187 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10188 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10189 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10190 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10191 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010192
10193 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10194 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10195
10196 global
10197 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10198
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010199 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010200 load-server-state-from-file
10201
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010202 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010203 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010204
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010205server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10206 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10207 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10209 no | no | yes | yes
10210
10211 Arguments:
10212 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10213
10214 <num | range>
10215 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10216 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10217 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10218 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10219
10220 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10221
10222 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10223
10224 <params*>
10225 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10226 keyword.
10227
10228 Examples:
10229 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10230 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10231 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10232
10233 # or
10234 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10235
10236 # would be equivalent to:
10237 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10238 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10239 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10240
10241
10242
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010243source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010244source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010245source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010246 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10248 yes | no | yes | yes
10249 Arguments :
10250 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10251 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010252
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010253 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010254 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10255 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10256 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10257 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10258 supported prefixes are :
10259 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10260 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10261 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010262 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10264 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010265
10266 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10267 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010268 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10269 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10270 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010271
10272 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10273 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10274 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10275 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10276 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10277 <addr>.
10278
10279 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10280 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10281 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10282 port.
10283
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010284 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10285 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10286 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10287 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010288 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010289 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10290 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10291 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10292 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10293 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10294 HTTP header.
10295
10296 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10297 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010298 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010299 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10300 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10301 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10302 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10303 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10304 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10305 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10306
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010307 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10308 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10309 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10310 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10311 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10312 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10313
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010314 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10315 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10316 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10317 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10318
10319 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10320 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10321 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10322 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10323 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10324 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10325
10326 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10327 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10328 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10329 there are two methods :
10330
10331 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10332 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10333 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10334 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10335 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10336 of the client ranges may be used.
10337
10338 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10339 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10340 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10341 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10342 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10343 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10344 same session.
10345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010346 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10347 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10348 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010349 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010350
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010351 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10352
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010353 Examples :
10354 backend private
10355 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10356 source 192.168.1.200
10357
10358 backend transparent_ssl1
10359 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10360 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10361
10362 backend transparent_ssl2
10363 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10364 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10365 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10366
10367 backend transparent_ssl3
10368 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10369 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10370 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10371
10372 backend transparent_smtp
10373 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10374 # with Tproxy version 4.
10375 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10376
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010377 backend transparent_http
10378 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10379 # proxy.
10380 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010382 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010383 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10384
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010385
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010386srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10387 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10388 the connection on the server side.
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10390 yes | no | yes | yes
10391 Arguments :
10392 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10393
10394 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10395 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010396 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10397 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010398
10399 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10400
10401
10402srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10403 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10404 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10405 server side.
10406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10407 yes | no | yes | yes
10408 Arguments :
10409 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10410 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10411 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10412 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10413
10414 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10415 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010416 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10417 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010418
10419 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10420
10421
10422srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10423 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 yes | no | yes | yes
10426 Arguments :
10427 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10428 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10429 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10430 document.
10431
10432 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10433 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010434 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10435 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010436
10437 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10438
10439
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010440stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10441 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010443 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010444
10445 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10446 matched.
10447
10448 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10449 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010451 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10452 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010454
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010455 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10456 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10457 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10458 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010459
10460 Example :
10461 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10462 backend stats_localhost
10463 stats enable
10464 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10465
10466 Example :
10467 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10468 backend stats_auth
10469 stats enable
10470 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10471 stats admin if TRUE
10472
10473 Example :
10474 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10475 userlist stats-auth
10476 group admin users admin
10477 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10478 group readonly users haproxy
10479 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10480
10481 backend stats_auth
10482 stats enable
10483 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10484 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10485 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10486 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010488 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10489 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10490 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010491
10492
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010493stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10494 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010496 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010497 Arguments :
10498 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10499
10500 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10501
10502 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10503 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10504 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10505 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10506 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10507 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10508
10509 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10510 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10511 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010512 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010513
10514 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10515 report using "stats scope".
10516
10517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10519 unobvious parameters.
10520
10521 Example :
10522 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10523 backend public_www
10524 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10525 stats enable
10526 stats hide-version
10527 stats scope .
10528 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010529 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10531 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10532
10533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10534 backend private_monitoring
10535 stats enable
10536 stats uri /admin?stats
10537 stats refresh 5s
10538
10539 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10540
10541
10542stats enable
10543 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010545 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010546 Arguments : none
10547
10548 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10549 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10550 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10551 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10552 - stats auth : no authentication
10553 - stats scope : no restriction
10554
10555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10557 unobvious parameters.
10558
10559 Example :
10560 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10561 backend public_www
10562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10563 stats enable
10564 stats hide-version
10565 stats scope .
10566 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010567 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010568 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10569 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10570
10571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10572 backend private_monitoring
10573 stats enable
10574 stats uri /admin?stats
10575 stats refresh 5s
10576
10577 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10578
10579
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010580stats hide-version
10581 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010583 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010584 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010586 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10587 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10588 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10589 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10590 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10591 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010593 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10594 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10595 unobvious parameters.
10596
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010597 Example :
10598 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10599 backend public_www
10600 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010601 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010602 stats hide-version
10603 stats scope .
10604 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010605 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010606 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10607 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010608
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010609 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10610 backend private_monitoring
10611 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010612 stats uri /admin?stats
10613 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010615 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010616
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010617
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010618stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10619 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10620 Access control for statistics
10621
10622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10623 no | no | yes | yes
10624
10625 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10626 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10627 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10628 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10629 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10630 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10631
10632 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10633 instance.
10634
10635 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10636 about ACL usage.
10637
10638
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010639stats realm <realm>
10640 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010642 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010643 Arguments :
10644 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10645 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10646 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10647
10648 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10649 using a backslash ('\').
10650
10651 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10652 only related to authentication.
10653
10654 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10655 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10656 unobvious parameters.
10657
10658 Example :
10659 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10660 backend public_www
10661 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10662 stats enable
10663 stats hide-version
10664 stats scope .
10665 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010667 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10668 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10669
10670 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10671 backend private_monitoring
10672 stats enable
10673 stats uri /admin?stats
10674 stats refresh 5s
10675
10676 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10677
10678
10679stats refresh <delay>
10680 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010682 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010683 Arguments :
10684 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10685 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10686 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10687 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10688 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10689 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10690
10691 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10692 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10693 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010694 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010695
10696 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10697 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10698 unobvious parameters.
10699
10700 Example :
10701 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10702 backend public_www
10703 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10704 stats enable
10705 stats hide-version
10706 stats scope .
10707 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010709 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10710 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10711
10712 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10713 backend private_monitoring
10714 stats enable
10715 stats uri /admin?stats
10716 stats refresh 5s
10717
10718 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10719
10720
10721stats scope { <name> | "." }
10722 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010724 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010725 Arguments :
10726 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10727 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10728 section in which the statement appears.
10729
10730 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10731 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10732 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10733 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10734 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10735 exists.
10736
10737 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10738 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10739 unobvious parameters.
10740
10741 Example :
10742 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10743 backend public_www
10744 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10745 stats enable
10746 stats hide-version
10747 stats scope .
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10751 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10752
10753 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10754 backend private_monitoring
10755 stats enable
10756 stats uri /admin?stats
10757 stats refresh 5s
10758
10759 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10760
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010761
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010762stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010763 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010765 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010766
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010767 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10769
10770 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10771 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10772
10773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010775 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010776
10777 Example :
10778 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10779 backend private_monitoring
10780 stats enable
10781 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10782 stats uri /admin?stats
10783 stats refresh 5s
10784
10785 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10786 global section.
10787
10788
10789stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010790 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10792 yes | yes | yes | yes
10793 Arguments : none
10794
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010795 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10797 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10798 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10799 - IP (socket, server)
10800 - cookie (backend, server)
10801
10802 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10803 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010804 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010805
10806 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10807
10808
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010809stats show-modules
10810 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 yes | yes | yes | yes
10813 Arguments : none
10814
10815 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10816 values as a tooltip.
10817
10818 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10819 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10820 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10821
10822 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10823
10824
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010825stats show-node [ <name> ]
10826 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010828 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010829 Arguments:
10830 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10831 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10832
10833 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10834 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836
10837 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10838 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10839 unobvious parameters.
10840
10841 Example:
10842 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10843 backend private_monitoring
10844 stats enable
10845 stats show-node Europe-1
10846 stats uri /admin?stats
10847 stats refresh 5s
10848
10849 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10850 section.
10851
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010852
10853stats uri <prefix>
10854 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010857 Arguments :
10858 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10859 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10860 query string.
10861
10862 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10863 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10864 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10865 possible to reach it in the application.
10866
10867 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010868 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010869 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10870 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10871 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10872 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10873
10874 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10875 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10876 an address or a port to statistics only.
10877
10878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10880 unobvious parameters.
10881
10882 Example :
10883 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10884 backend public_www
10885 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10886 stats enable
10887 stats hide-version
10888 stats scope .
10889 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010890 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010891 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10892 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10893
10894 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10895 backend private_monitoring
10896 stats enable
10897 stats uri /admin?stats
10898 stats refresh 5s
10899
10900 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10901
10902
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010903stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10904 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010906 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010907
10908 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010909 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010910 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010911 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010912 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10913
10914 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10915 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10916 the "stick-table" statement.
10917
10918 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10919 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10920 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10921 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10922 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10923
10924 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10925 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10926 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10927 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10928 transformation rules.
10929
10930 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10931 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10932 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10933 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10934 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10935 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10936 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10937
10938 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10939 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10940 ACL based conditions.
10941
10942 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10943 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10944 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10945 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10946
10947 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10948 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10949 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10950 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10951
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010952 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10953 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010955
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010956 Example :
10957 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10958 # last 30 minutes
10959 backend pop
10960 mode tcp
10961 balance roundrobin
10962 stick store-request src
10963 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10964 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10965 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10966
10967 backend smtp
10968 mode tcp
10969 balance roundrobin
10970 stick match src table pop
10971 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10972 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10973
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010974 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010975 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010976
10977
10978stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10979 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10981 no | no | yes | yes
10982
10983 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10984 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10985 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10986 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10987
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010988 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10989 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010991
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010992 Examples :
10993 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010994 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010995
10996 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10997 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10998 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10999
11000
11001 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11002 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11003 backend http
11004 mode http
11005 balance roundrobin
11006 stick on src table https
11007 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11008 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11009 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11010
11011 backend https
11012 mode tcp
11013 balance roundrobin
11014 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11015 stick on src
11016 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11017 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11018
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011019 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011020
11021
11022stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11023 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11025 no | no | yes | yes
11026
11027 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011028 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011029 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011030 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011031 server is selected.
11032
11033 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11034 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11035 the "stick-table" statement.
11036
11037 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11038 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11039 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11040 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11041 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11042 address.
11043
11044 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11045 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11046 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11047 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11048 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11049 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11050 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11051 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11052 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11053 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11054
11055 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11056 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11057 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11058 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11059 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11060 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11061 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11062
11063 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11064 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11065 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11066 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11067
11068 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11069 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11070 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11071 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11072 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11073 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011074 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11075 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11076 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11077 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11078 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11079 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011080
11081 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11082 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11083 the request.
11084
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011085 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11086 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011088
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011089 Example :
11090 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11091 # last 30 minutes
11092 backend pop
11093 mode tcp
11094 balance roundrobin
11095 stick store-request src
11096 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11097 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11098 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11099
11100 backend smtp
11101 mode tcp
11102 balance roundrobin
11103 stick match src table pop
11104 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11105 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11106
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011107 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011108 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011109
11110
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011111stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011112 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011113 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011114 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011116 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011117
11118 Arguments :
11119 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11120 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11121 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11122 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11123
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011124 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11125 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11126 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11127 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011129 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11130 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11131 instance.
11132
11133 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11134 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11135 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11136 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11137 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11138 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011139 to 32 characters.
11140
11141 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11142 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11143 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011144 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011145 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11146 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147
11148 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011149 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11150 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011151 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11152 increase.
11153
11154 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011155 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11156 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11157 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158
11159 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11160 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11161 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11162 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011163 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011164 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11165 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11166 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11167 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11168 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11169 parameter (see below).
11170
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011171 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11172 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11173 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11174 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11175 soft restart.
11176
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011177 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11178 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011179
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011180 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11181 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11182 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11183 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011184 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011185 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11187 if not expiration delay is specified.
11188
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011189 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11190 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11191 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11192 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11193 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11194 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11195 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11196 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11197 token.
11198
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011199 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11200 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11201 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11202 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011203 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11204 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11205 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11206 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11207 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11208 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11209 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11210 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11211 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11212 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11213 types and their arguments.
11214
11215 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11216 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11217 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11218 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11219
11220 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11221 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11222 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011223 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011224
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011225 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11226 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11227 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011228 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011229 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011230 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011231
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011232 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11233 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11234 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11235 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11236
11237 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11238 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11239 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11240 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11241 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11242 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11243
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011244 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11245 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11246 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11247 they were received.
11248
11249 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11250 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11251 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11252 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11253 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11254
11255 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11256 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11257 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11258 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11259 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11260
11261 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11262 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11263 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11264
11265 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11266 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11267 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11268 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11269 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11270
11271 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11272 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11273 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11274 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11275 the client side.
11276
11277 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11278 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11279 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11280 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11281 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11282 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11283 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11284
11285 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11286 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11287 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11288 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11289 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11290 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011291 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011292
11293 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11294 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11295 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11296 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11297 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11298 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11299
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011300 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11301 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11302 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11303 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11304 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11305
11306 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11307 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11308 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11309 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11310 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11311 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11312
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011313 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011314 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011315 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11316 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11317
11318 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11319 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11320 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11321 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11322 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11323 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11324 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11325 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11326 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11327 recommended for better fairness.
11328
11329 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011330 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011331 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11332 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11333
11334 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11335 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11336 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11337 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11338 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11339 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11340 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11341 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11342 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11343 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011344
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011345 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11346 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011347 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11348 reference it.
11349
11350 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11351 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011352 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11353 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11354 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011355
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011356 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11357 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11358 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11359 something that can be ignored.
11360
11361 Example:
11362 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11363 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11364 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11365 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11366
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011367 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011368 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011369
11370
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011371stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011372 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11374 no | no | yes | yes
11375
11376 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011377 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011378 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011379 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011380 server is selected.
11381
11382 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11383 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11384 the "stick-table" statement.
11385
11386 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11387 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11388 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11389 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11390
11391 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11392 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11393 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11394 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11395 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11396 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011397 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011398 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11399 rules.
11400
11401 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11402 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11403 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11404 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11405 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11406 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11407 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11408
11409 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11410 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11411 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11412 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11413
11414 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11415 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11416 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11417 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11418 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11419 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011420 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11421 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11422 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11423 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11424 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11425 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11426 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11427 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11428 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011429
11430 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11431
11432 Example :
11433 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11434 backend https
11435 mode tcp
11436 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011437 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011438 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011439
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011440 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11441 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11442
11443 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11444 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11445 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11446
11447 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11448 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011449
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011450 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11451 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11452 # at offset 44.
11453
11454 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11455 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11456
11457 # Learn on response if server hello.
11458 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011459
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011460 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11461 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11462
11463 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11464 extraction.
11465
11466
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011467tcp-check comment <string>
11468 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11469 it fails.
11470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11471 yes | no | yes | yes
11472
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011473 Arguments :
11474 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11475 rule fails.
11476
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011477 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11478 user-friendly error reporting.
11479
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011480 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11481 "tcp-check expect".
11482
11483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011484tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11485 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011486 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011487 Opens a new connection
11488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011490
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011491 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011492 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11493
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011494 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011495 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011496
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011497 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011498 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11499 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011500 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011501
11502 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011503
11504 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11505
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011506 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11507
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011508 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11509
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011510 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11511
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011512 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11513 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11514 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11515 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11516
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011517 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11518 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11519 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11520 haproxy -vv.
11521
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011522 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011523
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011524 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11525 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11526 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11527
11528 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11529 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11530 of the sequence.
11531
11532 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11533 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11534 do.
11535
11536 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11537 unset-var or comment rules.
11538
11539 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011540 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11541 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11542 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11543 option tcp-check
11544 tcp-check connect
11545 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11546 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11547 tcp-check send \r\n
11548 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11549 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11550 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11551 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11552 tcp-check send \r\n
11553 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11554 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11555
11556 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11557 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011558 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011559 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11560 tcp-check connect port 143
11561 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11562 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11563
11564 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11565
11566
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011567tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011568 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011569 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011570 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011571 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011573 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011574
11575 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011576 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11577
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011578 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11579 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11580 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11581 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11582 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11583 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11584 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11585 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11586 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11587 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11588
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011589 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011590 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11591 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011592 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11593 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11594 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11595
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011596 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11597 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11598 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011599 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11600 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011601 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11602 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011603 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11604 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011605 By default "L7OK" is used.
11606
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011607 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11608 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011609 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11610 supported :
11611 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11612 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011613 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11614 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11615 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11616 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11617 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011618
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011619 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011620 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011621 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11622 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11623 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11624 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011625 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11626
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011627 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11628 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11629 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11630 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11631
11632 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11633 informational message reported in logs if an error
11634 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11635 log-format string.
11636
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011637 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11638 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11639 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11640 followed by some converters.
11641
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011642 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11643 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11644 with the usual backslash ('\').
11645 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011646 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011647 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11648 used upper or lower case.
11649
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011650 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11651
11652 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11653 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11654 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11655 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11656 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11657 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11658 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11659 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11660
11661 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11662 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11663 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11664 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11665 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11666 expression.
11667
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011668 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11670 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11671 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11672 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11673 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11674
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011675 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11676 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11677 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11678 this exact hexadecimal string.
11679 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11680
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011681 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11682 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11683 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11684 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11685 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11686 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11687 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11688 size.
11689
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011690 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11691 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11692 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11693 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11694 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11695 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11696 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11697 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11698 in a binary string before matching the response's
11699 buffer.
11700
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011701 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011702 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011703 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11704 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11705 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11706 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11707 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11708 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11709 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11710 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11711 the null character.
11712
11713 Examples :
11714 # perform a POP check
11715 option tcp-check
11716 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11717
11718 # perform an IMAP check
11719 option tcp-check
11720 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11721
11722 # look for the redis master server
11723 option tcp-check
11724 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011725 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011726 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11727 tcp-check expect string role:master
11728 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11729 tcp-check expect string +OK
11730
11731
11732 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011733 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011734
11735
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011736tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11737tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11738 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11739 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011741 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011743 Arguments :
11744 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11745
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011746 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11747 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011748
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011749 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11750 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011751
11752 Examples :
11753 # look for the redis master server
11754 option tcp-check
11755 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11756 tcp-check expect string role:master
11757
11758 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011759 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011760
11761
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011762tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11763tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11764 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11765 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011767 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011768
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011769 Arguments :
11770 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011771
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011772 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11773 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011774
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011775 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11776 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11777 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011778
11779 Examples :
11780 # redis check in binary
11781 option tcp-check
11782 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11783 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11784
11785
11786 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011787 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011788
11789
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011790tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011791 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011793 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011794
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011795 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011796 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11797 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11798 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11799 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11800 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11801 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11802 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11803 and '-'.
11804
11805 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11806
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011807 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011808 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11809
11810
11811tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011812 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011814 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011815
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011816 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011817 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11818 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11821 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11823 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11824 and '-'.
11825
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011826 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011827 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11828
11829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011830tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11831 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11833 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011834 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011835 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11836 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011837
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011838 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011839
11840 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11841 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011842 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11843 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11844 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11845 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11846 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11847 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11850 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11851 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11852 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011853
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011854 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011855 - accept :
11856 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11857 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11858 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011860 - reject :
11861 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11862 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11863 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11864 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11865 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11866 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11867 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11868 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11869 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11870 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11871 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011872 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011873
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011874 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11875 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11876 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11877 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11878 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11879 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11880 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11881 hosts.
11882
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011883 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11884 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11885 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11886 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11887 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11888 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11889 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11890 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11891
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011892 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11893 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11894 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11895 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11896 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11897 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11898 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11899 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11900 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011901 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11902 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011903
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011904 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011905 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011906 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11907 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11908 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011909 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011910 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011911 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11912 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11913 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11914 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11915 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11916 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11917 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011920 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011922 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011923 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11924 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11925 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011927 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11928 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11929 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11930 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011932 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11933 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11934 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11935 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11936 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011937 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11938 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11939 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11940 layer7 information is extracted.
11941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011942 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11943 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11944 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11945 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11946 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011947
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011948 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11949 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11950 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11951 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11952
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011953 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11954 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11955 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11956 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11957
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011958 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11959 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11960 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11961 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11962 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011963
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011964 - set-src <expr> :
11965 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11966 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11967 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011968 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011970 Arguments:
11971 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11972 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011973
11974 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011975 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11976
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011977 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11978 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011979
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011980 - set-src-port <expr> :
11981 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11982 expression.
11983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011984 Arguments:
11985 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11986 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011987
11988 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011989 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11990
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011991 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11992 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11993 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011994
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011995 - set-dst <expr> :
11996 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11997 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11998 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11999 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12000 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12001
12002 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12003 followed by some converters.
12004
12005 Example:
12006
12007 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12008 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12009
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012010 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12011 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12012
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012013 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12014 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12015 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12016 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12017
12018
12019 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12020 followed by some converters.
12021
12022 Example:
12023
12024 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12025
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012026 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12027 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12028 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12029
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012030 - "silent-drop" :
12031 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012032 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012033 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12034 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12035 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12036 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12037 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012038 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12039 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012040 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12041 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012043 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12044 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12045 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12046 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012048 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12049 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12050 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012052 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12053 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12054 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012056 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012057 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012058 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012060 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12061 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12062 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012064 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012065 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12066 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012067
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012068 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12069
12070 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12071
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012072 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12073
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012074 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012075
12076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012077tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12078 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012080 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012082 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12083 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012085 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012087 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012088 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12089 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012090 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12091 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012093 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12094 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12095 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12096 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012097 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12098 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12099 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12100 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12101 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12102 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012103 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012104 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012106 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12107 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12108 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12109 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012110
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012111 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012112 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012113 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012114 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12115 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012116 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012117 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012118 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012119 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012120 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012121 - set-dst <expr>
12122 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012123 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012124 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012125 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012126 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012128 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012130 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12131 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012132 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12133 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012134
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012135 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12136 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12137 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12138 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12139 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12140 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012142 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012143 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12144 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012145
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012146 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12147 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12148 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12149 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12150 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12151 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012153 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012154 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12155 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12156 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12157 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12158 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12159 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12160 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12161 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12162 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12163 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012164
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012165 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012166 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12167 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12168 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012169
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012170 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12171 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12172
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012173 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012174 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12175 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012176
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012177 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12178 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012179 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012180 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12181 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012182 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012183 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012184 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012185 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12186 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012187 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012188 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12189 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012190
12191 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12192 followed by some converters.
12193
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012194 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12195 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12196 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12197 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12198 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12199 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12200 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012201 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012202 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12203 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12204
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012205 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12206
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012207 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12208 <var-name>.
12209
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012210 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12211 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12212 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12213 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12214 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12215
12216 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12217 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12218 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12219 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12220 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12221 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12222 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12223 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12224 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12225 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12226 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12227
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012228 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12229 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12230 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12231 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12232 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12233
12234 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12235
12236 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12237
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012238 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12239 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12240 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12241 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12242 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12243 evaluated.
12244
12245 Example:
12246 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12247
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012248 Example:
12249
12250 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012251 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012252
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012253 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012254 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012255 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012256 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12257 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012258 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012259 tcp-request content reject
12260
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012261 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12262 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12263 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12264 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12265 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12266 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12267 ...
12268 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012270 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012271 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12272 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12273 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012274 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012275
12276 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12277 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12278 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012279 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012280 tcp-request content reject
12281
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012282 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012283 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012284 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012285 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012286 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12287 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012288
12289 Example:
12290 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12291 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012292 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012295 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012296
12297 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012298 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012299 # protecting all our sites
12300 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012301 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12302 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012303 ...
12304 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12305
12306 backend http_dynamic
12307 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012308 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012309 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012310 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012311 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012312 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012313 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012315 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012317 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12318 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012319
12320
12321tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12322 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012324 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012325 Arguments :
12326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12328 as explained at the top of this document.
12329
12330 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12331 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12332 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12333 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12334 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12335
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012336 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12337 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12338 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12339 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12340
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012341 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12342 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012343 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012344 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012345 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12346 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12347 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12348 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012349
12350 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12351 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12352 it pass through unaffected.
12353
12354 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12355 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12356 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012357 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012358 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12359 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012360 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12361 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12362 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012364 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012365 "timeout client".
12366
12367
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012368tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12369 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12371 no | no | yes | yes
12372 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012373 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12374 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012375
12376 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012378 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012379 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12380 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012381 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12382 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012383
12384 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12385
12386 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12387 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12388 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12389 inserted.
12390
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012391 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012392 - accept :
12393 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12394 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12395 the rules evaluation.
12396
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012397 - close :
12398 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12399 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12400 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12401 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12402 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12403 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012404 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012405 protocols.
12406
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012407 - reject :
12408 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12409 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012410 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012411
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012412 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12413 Sets a variable.
12414
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012415 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12416 Unsets a variable.
12417
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012418 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12419 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12420 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12421 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12422
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012423 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12424 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12425 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12426 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12427
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012428 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12429 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12430 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12431 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12432 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012433
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012434 - "silent-drop" :
12435 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012436 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012437 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12438 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12439 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12440 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12441 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012442 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12443 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012444 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12445 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012446 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012447 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12448 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12449 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12450 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12451
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012452 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12453 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12454
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012455 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12456 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12457 for changing the default action to a reject.
12458
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012459 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12460 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12461 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12462 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012463 period.
12464
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012465 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12466 declared inline.
12467
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012468 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12469 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012470 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012471 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12472 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012473 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012474 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012475 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012476 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12477 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012479 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12480 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012481
12482 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12483 followed by some converters.
12484
12485 Example:
12486
12487 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12488
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012489 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12490 <var-name>.
12491
12492 Example:
12493
12494 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12495
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012496 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12497 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12498 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12499 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12500 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12501
12502 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12503
12504 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12505
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012506 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12507
12508 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12509
12510
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012511tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12512 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12514 no | yes | yes | no
12515 Arguments :
12516 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12517 below.
12518
12519 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12520
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012521 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012522 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12523 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12524 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12525 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12526 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12527 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12528 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012529 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012530 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12531 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12532 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12533 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12534 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12535 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12536 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12537 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12538 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12539 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12540 instead.
12541
12542 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12543 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12544 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12545 rules which may be inserted.
12546
12547 Several types of actions are supported :
12548 - accept : the request is accepted
12549 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12550 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12551 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012552 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012553 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012554 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012555 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012556 - silent-drop
12557
12558 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12559 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12560 sections for a complete description.
12561
12562 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12563 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12564 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12565
12566 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12567 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12568 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12569 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12570 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12571
12572 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12573 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12574
12575 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12576 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12577 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12578
12579 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12580 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12581 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12582
12583 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12584 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12585 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12586
12587 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12588 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12589 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12590
12591 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12592
12593 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12594
12595
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012596tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12597 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12599 no | no | yes | yes
12600 Arguments :
12601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12603 as explained at the top of this document.
12604
12605 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12606
12607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012608timeout check <timeout>
12609 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12610 established.
12611
12612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12613 yes | no | yes | yes
12614 Arguments:
12615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12617 as explained at the top of this document.
12618
12619 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12620 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012622 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012623 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12624 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12625 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012626
12627 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12628 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12629
12630 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12631 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012632 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012633
12634 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12635 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12636 forget about it.
12637
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012638 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12639 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012640
12641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012642timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012643 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12645 yes | yes | yes | no
12646 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012647 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12649 as explained at the top of this document.
12650
12651 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12652 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12653 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012654 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12655 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12656 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12657 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012658 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12659 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12660 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012661 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012662 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012663 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12664 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012665 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12666 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012667
12668 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12669 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12670 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12671 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012672 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012673 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12674
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012675 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012676
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012677 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012679
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012680timeout client-fin <timeout>
12681 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12683 yes | yes | yes | no
12684 Arguments :
12685 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12686 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12687 as explained at the top of this document.
12688
12689 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12690 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12691 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12692 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12693 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12694 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12695 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012696 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12697 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12698 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012699
12700 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12701 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12702 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12703
12704 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12705
12706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012707timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012708 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12710 yes | no | yes | yes
12711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012712 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012713 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12714 as explained at the top of this document.
12715
12716 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012717 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012718 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012719 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012720 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12721 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012722
12723 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12724 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12725 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12726 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012727 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012728 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12729
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012730 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012731
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012732
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012733timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12734 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12736 yes | yes | yes | yes
12737 Arguments :
12738 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12739 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12740 as explained at the top of this document.
12741
12742 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12743 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12744 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12745 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12746 once the request has started to present itself.
12747
12748 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12749 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12750 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12751 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12752 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12753
12754 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12755 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12756 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12757 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12758
12759 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12760 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012761 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012762 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12763 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012764 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012765
12766 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12767 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12768 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12769 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12770
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012771 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12772 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012773 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12774
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012775 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12776
12777
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012778timeout http-request <timeout>
12779 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012781 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012782 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12785 as explained at the top of this document.
12786
12787 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12788 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12789 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12790 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12791 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12792 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12793 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012794 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12795 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12796 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12797 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012798 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012799 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12800 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012801
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012802 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12803 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12804 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12805 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12806 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012807 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012808
12809 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12810 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012811 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012812 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12813 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12814
12815 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012816 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12817 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12818 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012819
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012820 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012821 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012822
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012823
12824timeout queue <timeout>
12825 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12827 yes | no | yes | yes
12828 Arguments :
12829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12831 as explained at the top of this document.
12832
12833 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12834 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12835 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12836 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12837 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12838
12839 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12840 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12841 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12842 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12843
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012844 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012845
12846
12847timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012848 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12850 yes | no | yes | yes
12851 Arguments :
12852 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12854 as explained at the top of this document.
12855
12856 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12857 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12858 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12859 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12860 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12861 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12862 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12863
12864 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12865 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12866 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12867 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12868 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012869 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012870 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012871 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12872 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012873 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12874 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012875
12876 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12877 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12878 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12879 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012880 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012881 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12882
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012883 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012884
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012885
12886timeout server-fin <timeout>
12887 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12889 yes | no | yes | yes
12890 Arguments :
12891 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12892 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12893 as explained at the top of this document.
12894
12895 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12896 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12897 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12898 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12899 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12900 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12901 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12902 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12903 situations, it should not be needed.
12904
12905 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12906 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12907 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12908
12909 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12910
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012911
12912timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012913 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12915 yes | yes | yes | yes
12916 Arguments :
12917 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12918 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12919 as explained at the top of this document.
12920
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012921 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12922 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12923 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012924
12925 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12926 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12927 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12928 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012929 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012930
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012931 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012932
12933
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012934timeout tunnel <timeout>
12935 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12937 yes | no | yes | yes
12938 Arguments :
12939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12941 as explained at the top of this document.
12942
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012943 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012944 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12945 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12946 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012947 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12948 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012949 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12950 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12951 specified.
12952
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012953 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12954 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12955 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12956 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12957 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12958 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12959 state.
12960
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012961 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12962 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12963 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12964 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012965 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012966
12967 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12968 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12969 forget about it.
12970
12971 Example :
12972 defaults http
12973 option http-server-close
12974 timeout connect 5s
12975 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012976 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012977 timeout server 30s
12978 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12979
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012980 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012981
12982
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012983transparent (deprecated)
12984 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012987 Arguments : none
12988
12989 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12990 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12991 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12992 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12993 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12994 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12995 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12996 appropriate server.
12997
12998 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12999
13000 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13001 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13002
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013003 See also: "option transparent"
13004
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013005unique-id-format <string>
13006 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13008 yes | yes | yes | no
13009 Arguments :
13010 <string> is a log-format string.
13011
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013012 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13013 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13014 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13015 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013016
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013017 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13018 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13019 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13020 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13021 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13022 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13023 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13024 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013025
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013026 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13027 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013028
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013029 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013030
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013031 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013032
13033 will generate:
13034
13035 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13036
13037 See also: "unique-id-header"
13038
13039unique-id-header <name>
13040 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13042 yes | yes | yes | no
13043 Arguments :
13044 <name> is the name of the header.
13045
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013046 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13047 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013048
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013049 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013050
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013051 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013052 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13053
13054 will generate:
13055
13056 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13057
13058 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013059
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013060use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013061 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13063 no | yes | yes | no
13064 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013065 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13066 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013068 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13069 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013070
13071 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13072 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13073 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013074 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013075 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013076 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13077 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013078
13079 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13080 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13081 assign the backend.
13082
13083 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13084 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13085 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13086 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13087 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13088 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13089
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013090 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013091 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013092 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13093 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13094 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13095
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013096 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13097 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13098 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13099 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13100 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13101 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13102 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13103 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13104 cannot be forced from the request.
13105
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013106 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013107 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13108 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13109
13110 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13111 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013112
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013113use-fcgi-app <name>
13114 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13116 no | no | yes | yes
13117 Arguments :
13118 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13119
13120 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013121
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013122use-server <server> if <condition>
13123use-server <server> unless <condition>
13124 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13126 no | no | yes | yes
13127 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013128 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13129 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013130
13131 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13132
13133 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13134 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13135 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13136
13137 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13138 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13139 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13140 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13141 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13142 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13143 matches will assign the server.
13144
13145 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13146 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13147 with the next rules until one matches.
13148
13149 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13150 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13151 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13152 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13153
13154 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13155 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13156 stripped.
13157
13158 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13159 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013160 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13161 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13162 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013163
13164 Example :
13165 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13166 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13167 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13168 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013169 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013170 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013171 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013172 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13173 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13174
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013175 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13176 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13177 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13178 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013179 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013180 and we fall back to load balancing.
13181
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013182 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013184
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131855. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013186--------------------------
13187
13188The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13189depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13190settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13191written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13192described in this section.
13193
13194
131955.1. Bind options
13196-----------------
13197
13198The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13199as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13200no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13201parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13202while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13203provided immediately after the setting name.
13204
13205The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13206
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013207accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13208 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13209 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13210 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13211 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13212 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13213 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13214 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13215 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13216 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013217 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13218 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13219 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013220
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013221accept-proxy
13222 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013223 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13224 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013225 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13226 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13227 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13228 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013229 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013230 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13231 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013232 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13233 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013234
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013235allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013236 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013237 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013238 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013239 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13240 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013241
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013242alpn <protocols>
13243 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13244 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13245 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013246 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013247 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013248 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13249 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13250 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13251 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13252 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13253 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13254 preference, like below :
13255
13256 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013258backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013259 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013260 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13261
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013262curves <curves>
13263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13264 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13265 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13266 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13267 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13268 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13269
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013270ecdhe <named curve>
13271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013272 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13273 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013274
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013275ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13277 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13278 client's certificate.
13279
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013280ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13282 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13283 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13284 error is ignored.
13285
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013286ca-sign-file <cafile>
13287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13288 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13289 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13290 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13291 'generate-certificates' for details.
13292
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013293ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13295 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13296 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13297 'generate-certificates' for details.
13298
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013299ca-verify-file <cafile>
13300 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13301 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13302 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13303 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13304 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013306ciphers <ciphers>
13307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13308 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013310 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013311 information and recommendations see e.g.
13312 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13313 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13314 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13315
13316ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13318 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13319 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13320 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013321 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13322 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013323
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013324crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13326 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13327 to verify client's certificate.
13328
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013329crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13331 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13332 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13333 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13334 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013335 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13336 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013337
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013338 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13339 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13340
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013341 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13342 are loaded.
13343
13344 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013345 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13346 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13347 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13348 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13349 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13350 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13351 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013352 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013353
13354 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13355 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13356 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13357 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013358 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13359 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013360
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013361 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013363 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013364 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013365 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13366 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013367 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13368 clients).
13369
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013370 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13371 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13372 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13373 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13374 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13375 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13376 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13377 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13378 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13379 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13380 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13381 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13382 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13383
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013384 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13385 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13386 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13387 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13388 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13389
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013390 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13391 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13392 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13393 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013394
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013395 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13396 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13397 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013398
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013399crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013401 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013402 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013403 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013404
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013405crt-list <file>
13406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013407 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13408 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013409
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013410 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13411
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013412 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13413 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13414 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13415 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13416 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013417
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013418 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013419 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13420 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13421 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13422 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13423 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013424 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13425 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13426 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013427
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013428 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13429 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13430 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013431
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013432 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13433
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013434 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13435 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13436 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13437 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13438 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13439 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13440 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13441 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013442
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013443 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013444 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013445 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013446 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013447 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013448 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450defer-accept
13451 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13452 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13453 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013455 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13456 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13457 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13458 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13459 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13460 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13461 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13462
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013463expose-fd listeners
13464 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13465 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013466 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13467 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013469
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013470force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013471 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013472 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013473 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013474 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013475
13476force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013477 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013478 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013479 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013480
13481force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013482 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013483 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013484 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013485
13486force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013487 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013488 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013489 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013490
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013491force-tlsv13
13492 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13493 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013494 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013495
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013496generate-certificates
13497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13498 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13499 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13500 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13501 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13502 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13503 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13504 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13505 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13506 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13507 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13508
13509 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13510 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013511 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013512 certificate is used many times.
13513
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013514gid <gid>
13515 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13516 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13517 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13518 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13519 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13520
13521group <group>
13522 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13523 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13524 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13525 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13526 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13527
13528id <id>
13529 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13530 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13531 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13532 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13533
13534interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013535 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13536 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13537 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13538 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13539 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13540 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013541 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13542 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13543 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13544 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13545 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13546 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013547
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013548level <level>
13549 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13550 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13551 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013552 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013553 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13554 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13555 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013557 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013558 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013559 all counters).
13560
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013561severity-output <format>
13562 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13563 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13564 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13565 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13566 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13567 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13568 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13569 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13570 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13571 rfc5424 convention.
13572
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013573maxconn <maxconn>
13574 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13575 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13576 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13577 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13578 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13579 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13580 eat all memory.
13581
13582mode <mode>
13583 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13584 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13585 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13586 UNIX sockets.
13587
13588mss <maxseg>
13589 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13590 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13591 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13592 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13593 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13594 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13595 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13596 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13597 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13598 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13599 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13600
13601name <name>
13602 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13603 page.
13604
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013605namespace <name>
13606 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13607 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13608 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13609 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13610
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013611nice <nice>
13612 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13613 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13614 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13615 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13616 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13617 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13618 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13619 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13620 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13621 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13622 one for an RDP socket.
13623
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013624no-ca-names
13625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13626 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013627 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013628
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013629no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013631 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013632 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013633 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013634 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13635 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013636
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013637no-tls-tickets
13638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13639 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13640 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013641 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13642 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013643 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13644 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13645 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013646
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013647no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013649 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013650 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013651 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013652 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13653 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013654
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013655no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013657 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013658 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013659 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013660 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13661 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013662
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013663no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013665 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013666 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013667 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013668 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13669 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013670
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013671no-tlsv13
13672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13673 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13674 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13675 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013676 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13677 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013678
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013679npn <protocols>
13680 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13681 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13682 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013683 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013684 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013685 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13686 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13687 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13688 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13689 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013690
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013691prefer-client-ciphers
13692 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13693 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13694 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013695 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13696 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13697 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013698
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013699process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013700 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013701 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013702 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013703 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13704 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13705 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13706 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013707 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013708 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13709 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13710 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13711 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13712 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013713
13714 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13715
13716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13718 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13719 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13720 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13721 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13722 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13723 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013724
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013725proto <name>
13726 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13727 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13728 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013729 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13730 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13731
13732 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13733 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13734 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13735 also reported (flag=HTX).
13736
13737 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13738 a bind line :
13739
13740 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13741 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13742 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13743
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013744 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013745 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013746 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013747 h2" on the bind line.
13748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013749ssl
13750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013751 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013752 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13753 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013754 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13755 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013756
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013757ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13758 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013759 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13760 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13761 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013762 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13763
13764ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013765 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13766 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13767 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13768 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013769
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013770strict-sni
13771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13772 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13773 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13774 See the "crt" option for more information.
13775
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013776tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013777 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013778 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13779 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013781 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13782 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13783 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13784 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13785 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13786 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13787 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13788
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013789tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013790 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013791 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13792 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13793 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13794 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13795 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13796 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13797 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013798 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13799 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13800 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013801
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013802tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13803 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013804 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13805 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13806 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13807 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13808 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13809 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13810 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13811 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13812 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13813 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013814 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13815 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013817transparent
13818 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13819 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13820 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13821 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13822 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13823 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13824 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13825 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13826 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13827 so check for support with your vendor.
13828
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013829v4v6
13830 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13831 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13832 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13833 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013834 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013835
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013836v6only
13837 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13838 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13839 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013840 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13841 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013842
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013843uid <uid>
13844 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13845 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13846 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13847 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13848 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13849
13850user <user>
13851 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13852 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13853 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13854 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13855 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13856
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013857verify [none|optional|required]
13858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13859 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13860 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13861 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13862 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013863 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13864 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13865 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13866 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013867
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200138685.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013869------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013871The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13872which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13873arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13874settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13875after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13876Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13877address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013879 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013880 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013881
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013882Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13883keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013885The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013886
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013887addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013888 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013889 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13890 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13891 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13892 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13893 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013894
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013895agent-check
13896 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013897 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013898 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13899 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13900 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013901
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013902 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013903 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013904 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13905 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13906 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13909 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13910 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13911 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13912 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013913
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013914 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013916
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013917 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13918 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13919 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013920
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013921 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13922 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13923 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013924
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013925 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013926 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13927 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13928 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13929 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013930 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013931 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013932
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013933 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13934 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013935
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013936 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13937 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13938 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13939 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13940 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13941 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13942 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13943 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13944 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013945
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013946 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13947 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013948 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13949 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13950 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013951 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013952
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013953 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013954 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013955
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013956agent-send <string>
13957 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13958 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13959 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13960 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13961 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13962
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013963agent-inter <delay>
13964 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13965 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13966
13967 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13968 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13969 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13970 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13971 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13972 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13973 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13974 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13975 of backends use the same servers.
13976
13977 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13978
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013979agent-addr <addr>
13980 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13981
13982 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13983 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13984 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13985 hostname, it will be resolved.
13986
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013987agent-port <port>
13988 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13989
13990 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13991
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013992allow-0rtt
13993 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013994 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13995 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013996
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013997alpn <protocols>
13998 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13999 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14000 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014001 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014002 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14003 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14004 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14005 now obsolete NPN extension.
14006 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14007 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14008
14009 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014011backup
14012 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14013 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14014 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14015 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014016 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14017 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014018
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014019ca-file <cafile>
14020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14021 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14022 server's certificate.
14023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014024check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014025 This option enables health checks on a server:
14026 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14027 considered available.
14028 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14029 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14030 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14031 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14032 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14033 set.
14034 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14035 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14036 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14037 exchanges succeed.
14038
14039 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14040 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14041 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14042 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14043 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014044 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014045 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14046
14047 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14048 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14049
14050 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14051 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14052
14053 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14054 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14055 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14056 available.
14057
14058 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14059 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14060 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14061
14062 Example:
14063 # simple tcp check
14064 backend foo
14065 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14066 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14067 backend foo
14068 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14069 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14070 backend foo
14071 option tcp-check
14072 tcp-check connect
14073 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014074
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014075check-send-proxy
14076 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14077 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14078 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14079 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14080 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14081 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14082 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14083
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014084check-alpn <protocols>
14085 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14086 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14087 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14088
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014089check-proto <name>
14090 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14091 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14092 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014093 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14094 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14095
14096 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14097 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14098 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14099 also reported (flag=HTX).
14100
14101 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14102 directive on a server line:
14103
14104 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14105 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14106 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14107 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14108
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014109 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014110 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14111 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14112
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014113check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014114 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014115 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14116 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014117
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014118check-ssl
14119 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14120 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14121 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14122 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014123 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014124 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14125 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014127 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14128 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014129
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014130check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014131 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014132 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14133 for normal traffic.
14134
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014135ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14137 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14138 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014139 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14140 information and recommendations see e.g.
14141 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14142 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14143 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014144
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014145ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14147 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14148 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14149 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014150 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14151 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14152 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014154cookie <value>
14155 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14156 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14157 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14158 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14159 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14160 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14161 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14162
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014163crl-file <crlfile>
14164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14165 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14166 to verify server's certificate.
14167
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014168crt <cert>
14169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14170 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14171 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14172 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14173 certificate request.
14174
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014175disabled
14176 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14177 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14178 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14179 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14180 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014181 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014182
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014183enabled
14184 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14185 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14186 default value.
14187 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14188 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014190error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014191 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14192 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14193 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014195 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014197fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014198 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14199 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14200 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14201
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014202force-sslv3
14203 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14204 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014205 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014206 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014207
14208force-tlsv10
14209 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014210 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014211 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014212
14213force-tlsv11
14214 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014215 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014216 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014217
14218force-tlsv12
14219 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014220 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014221 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014222
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014223force-tlsv13
14224 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14225 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014226 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014228id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014229 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14230 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14231 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014232
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014233init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14234 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14235 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014236 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014237 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14238 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14239 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14240 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14241 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14242 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14243 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14244 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14245 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014246 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014247 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14248 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14249 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14250 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14251 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14252 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014253 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014254
14255 Example:
14256 defaults
14257 # never fail on address resolution
14258 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014260inter <delay>
14261fastinter <delay>
14262downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014263 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14264 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14265 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14266 between checks depending on the server state :
14267
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014268 Server state | Interval used
14269 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14270 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14271 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14272 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14273 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14274 or yet unchecked. |
14275 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14276 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14277 | "inter" otherwise.
14278 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014280 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14281 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14282 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14283 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014284 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14285 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14286 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14287 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14288 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014289
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014290log-proto <logproto>
14291 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14292 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14293 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14294 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014296maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014297 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14298 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014299 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14300 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014301 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14302 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14303 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14304 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14305
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014306 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14307 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14308 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14309 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14310 than 50 concurrent requests.
14311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014312maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014313 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14314 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14315 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14316 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014317 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14318 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14319 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14320 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14321 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14322 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14323 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014325max-reuse <count>
14326 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14327 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14328 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14329 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14330 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14331 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14332 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14333 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014335minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014336 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14337 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14338 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14339 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14340 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14341 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014342 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014343 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014344
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014345namespace <name>
14346 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14347 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14348 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14349 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14350
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014351no-agent-check
14352 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14353 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14354 default value.
14355 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14356 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14357
14358no-backup
14359 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14360 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14361 default value.
14362 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14363 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14364
14365no-check
14366 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14367 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14368 default value.
14369 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14370 "default-server" "check" setting.
14371
14372no-check-ssl
14373 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14374 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14375 default value.
14376 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14377 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14378
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014379no-send-proxy
14380 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14381 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14382 default value.
14383 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14384 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14385
14386no-send-proxy-v2
14387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14389 default value.
14390 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14391 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14392
14393no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14394 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14395 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14396 default value.
14397 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14398 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14399
14400no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14401 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14402 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14403 default value.
14404 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14405 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14406
14407no-ssl
14408 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14409 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14410 default value.
14411 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14412 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14413
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014414 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14415 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14416 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14417
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014418no-ssl-reuse
14419 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14420 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14421 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14422 and for paranoid users.
14423
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014424no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014425 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14426 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014427 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014428
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014429 Supported in default-server: No
14430
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014431no-tls-tickets
14432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14433 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14434 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014435 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14436 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014437 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14438 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14439 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014440 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014442no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014443 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014444 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14445 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014446 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14447 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014448 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014449
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014450 Supported in default-server: No
14451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014452no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014453 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014454 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14455 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014456 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14457 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014458 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014459
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014460 Supported in default-server: No
14461
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014462no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014463 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014464 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14465 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014466 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14467 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014468 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014469
14470 Supported in default-server: No
14471
14472no-tlsv13
14473 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14474 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14475 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14476 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14477 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014478 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014479
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014480 Supported in default-server: No
14481
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014482no-verifyhost
14483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14485 default value.
14486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14487 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014488
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014489no-tfo
14490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14492 default value.
14493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14494 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14495
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014496non-stick
14497 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14498 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14499 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14500
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014501npn <protocols>
14502 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14503 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14504 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014505 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014506 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14507 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14508 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014510observe <mode>
14511 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14512 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14513 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14514 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14515 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14516 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014517 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014518
14519 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014521on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014522 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14523 Currently, four modes are available:
14524 - fastinter: force fastinter
14525 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14526 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14527 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14528 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14529
14530 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14531
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014532on-marked-down <action>
14533 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14534 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014535 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14536 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14537 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14538 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14539 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14540 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14541 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14542 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014543
14544 Actions are disabled by default
14545
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014546on-marked-up <action>
14547 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14548 Currently one action is available:
14549 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14550 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14551 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14552 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014553 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14554 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014555 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14556 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14557
14558 Actions are disabled by default
14559
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014560pool-low-conn <max>
14561 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14562 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14563 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14564 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14565 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14566 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14567 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14568 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14569 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14570 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014571 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14572 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14573 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14574 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014575
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014576pool-max-conn <max>
14577 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14578 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14579 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14580 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14581 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14582 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14583
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014584pool-purge-delay <delay>
14585 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014586 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014587 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014589port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014590 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014591 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14592 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14593 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14594 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14595 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014596
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014597proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014598 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14599 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14600 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014601 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14602 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14603
14604 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14605 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14606 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14607 also reported (flag=HTX).
14608
14609 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14610 a server line :
14611
14612 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14613 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14614 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14615 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14616
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014617 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014618 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014620redir <prefix>
14621 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14622 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14623 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14624 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14625 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14626 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14627 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14628 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014629 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014630 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014631 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14632 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14633 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14634 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14635
14636 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014638rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014639 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14640 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14641 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14642
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014643resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14644 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14645 server.
14646
14647 Available options:
14648
14649 * allow-dup-ip
14650 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14651 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14652 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14653 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14654 For such case, simply enable this option.
14655 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14656
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014657 * ignore-weight
14658 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14659 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14660 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14661
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014662 * prevent-dup-ip
14663 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14664 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14665 same fqdn.
14666 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14667
14668 Example:
14669 backend b_myapp
14670 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14671 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14672 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14673
14674 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14675 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14676 it
14677 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14678 different address
14679
14680 Default value: not set
14681
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014682resolve-prefer <family>
14683 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14684 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14685 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14686 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14687
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014688 Default value: ipv6
14689
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014690 Example:
14691
14692 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014693
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014694resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014695 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014696 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014697 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014698 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14699 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014700 configured network, another address is selected.
14701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014702 Example:
14703
14704 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014705
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014706resolvers <id>
14707 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14708 hostname.
14709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014710 Example:
14711
14712 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014713
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014714 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014715
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014716send-proxy
14717 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14718 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14719 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14720 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014721 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14722 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14723 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14724 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14725 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14726 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14727 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14728 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14729 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14730 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014731 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14732 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014733
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014734send-proxy-v2
14735 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14736 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14737 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14738 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014739 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14740 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14741 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14742 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014743
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014744proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014745 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14746 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14747
14748 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14749 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14750 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14751 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14752 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14753 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14754 connection is supported).
14755 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14756 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14757 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14758 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14759 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14760 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14761 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014762
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014763send-proxy-v2-ssl
14764 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14765 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14766 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14767 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14768 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14769 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14770 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014771 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14772 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014773
14774send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14775 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14776 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14777 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14778 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14779 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14780 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14781 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14782 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014783 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14784 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014786slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014787 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14788 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14789 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14790 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14791 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14792 parameters :
14793
14794 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14795 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14796
14797 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14798 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14799 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14800 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14801
14802 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14803 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14804 seen as failed.
14805
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014806sni <expression>
14807 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14808 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14809 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14810 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014811 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14812 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014813 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014814 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14815 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014816
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014817source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014818source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014819source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014820 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14821 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14822 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14823 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14824
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014825 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14826 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14827 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14828 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14829 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14830 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14831 server.
14832
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014833 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14834 specifying the source address without port(s).
14835
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014836ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014837 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14838 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14839 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14840 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14841 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14842 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014843 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14844 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014845
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014846ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14847 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14848 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14849 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14850
14851ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14852 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14853 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14854 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14855
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014856ssl-reuse
14857 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14858 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14859 default value.
14860 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14861 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14862
14863stick
14864 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14865 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14866 default value.
14867 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14868 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014869
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014870socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014871 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014872 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14873 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14874
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014875tcp-ut <delay>
14876 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14877 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14878 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014879 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014880 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14881 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14882 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14883 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14884 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14885 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14886 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14887 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14888 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14889
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014890tfo
14891 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14892 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14893 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14894 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14895 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014896 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014898track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014899 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14900 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14901 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14902 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014903 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14904
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014905tls-tickets
14906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14908 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014909 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14910 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14911 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014912 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014913 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014914
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014915verify [none|required]
14916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014917 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014918 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14919 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014920 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014921 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14922 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14923 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14924 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14925 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14926 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14927 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14928 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014929
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014930verifyhost <hostname>
14931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014932 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14933 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14934 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14935 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14936 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14937 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14938 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14939 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014941weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014942 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14943 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14944 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014945 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14946 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14947 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14948 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14949 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14950 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014951
14952
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149535.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14954-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014955
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014956HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14957using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014958configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014959This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14960can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14961workload.
14962This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14963resolution at run time.
14964Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14965carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14966
14967
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149685.3.1. Global overview
14969----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014970
14971As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14972different steps of the process life:
14973
14974 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14975 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14976 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14977
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014978 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14979 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014980
14981A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14982 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14983 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14984 resolution to know this new IP.
14985
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014986When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014987HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014988SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14989from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14990will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14991will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014992
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014993A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014994 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014995 first valid response.
14996
14997 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14998 servers return an error.
14999
15000
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150015.3.2. The resolvers section
15002----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015003
15004This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015005HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15006contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015007
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015008When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15009uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15010is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15011answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15012
15013When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015014used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015015
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015016 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15017 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15018 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015019
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015020 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15021 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015022
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015023 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15024 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15025 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015026
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015027For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15028following scenarios are possible:
15029
15030 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15031 ignored
15032
15033 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15034 applied
15035
15036 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15037 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15038
15039 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15040 retries the query with a new type
15041
15042 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15043 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015044
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015045As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15046a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015047<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015048
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015049
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015050resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015051 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015052
15053A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15054
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015055accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015056 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015057 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015058 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15059 by RFC 6891)
15060
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015061 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15062 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15063 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15064 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15065 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15066 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015067
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015068nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15069 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15070 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15071 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15072 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15073 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15074 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15075 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15076 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15077 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015078 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15079
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015080parse-resolv-conf
15081 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15082 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15083 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15084
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015085hold <status> <period>
15086 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15087 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015088 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015089 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015090 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15091 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15092 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15093
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015094 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015095
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015096resolve_retries <nb>
15097 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15098 giving up.
15099 Default value: 3
15100
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015101 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15102 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15103 type.
15104
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015105timeout <event> <time>
15106 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15107 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15108 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015109 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15110 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015111 Default value: 1s
15112 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015113 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015114 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015115 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15116 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15117
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015118 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015119
15120 resolvers mydns
15121 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15122 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015123 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015124 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015125 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015126 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015127 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015128 hold other 30s
15129 hold refused 30s
15130 hold nx 30s
15131 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015132 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015133 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015134
15135
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151366. Cache
15137---------
15138
15139HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15140(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15141RAM.
15142
15143The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15144this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15145
15146If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15147independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15148when we try to allocate a new one.
15149
15150The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15151
15152It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15153"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15154for more details.
15155
15156When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15157replaced by "<CACHE>".
15158
15159
151606.1. Limitation
15161----------------
15162
15163The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15164
15165- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015166- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15167 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15168 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015169- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15170- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015171- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15172 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15173 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015174- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15175 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015176- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15177 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15178 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015179
15180- If the request is not a GET
15181- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15182- If the request contains an Authorization header
15183
15184
151856.2. Setup
15186-----------
15187
15188To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15189the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15190
15191
151926.2.1. Cache section
15193---------------------
15194
15195cache <name>
15196 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15197 size of cache is mandatory.
15198
15199total-max-size <megabytes>
15200 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15201 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15202
15203max-object-size <bytes>
15204 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15205 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15206 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15207
15208max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015209 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015210 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15211 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15212 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15213 default.
15214
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015215process-vary <on/off>
15216 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015217 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15218 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15219 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015220 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015221
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015222max-secondary-entries <number>
15223 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15224 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15225 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15226
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015227
152286.2.2. Proxy section
15229---------------------
15230
15231http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15232 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15233 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15234 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15235 after this one.
15236
15237http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15238 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15239 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15240 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15241 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15242
15243
15244Example:
15245
15246 backend bck1
15247 mode http
15248
15249 http-request cache-use foobar
15250 http-response cache-store foobar
15251 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15252
15253 cache foobar
15254 total-max-size 4
15255 max-age 240
15256
15257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152587. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15259----------------------------------
15260
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015261HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15263The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15264these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15265but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15266data called patterns.
15267
15268
152697.1. ACL basics
15270---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015271
15272The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15273content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15274from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15275simple :
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015278 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15280 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15283adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015284
15285In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015288
15289This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15290Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15291and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015292an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15293conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15294as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15295are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015296
15297ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15298'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15299which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15300
15301There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15302performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15305specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15306this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015307methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15308ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309
15310Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15311 - boolean
15312 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15313 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15314 - string
15315 - data block
15316
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015317Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15318converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15319would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15320The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15321which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15322
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015323Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15324keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15325fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15326which are summarized in the table below :
15327
15328 +---------------------+-----------------+
15329 | Sample or converter | Default |
15330 | output type | matching method |
15331 +---------------------+-----------------+
15332 | boolean | bool |
15333 +---------------------+-----------------+
15334 | integer | int |
15335 +---------------------+-----------------+
15336 | ip | ip |
15337 +---------------------+-----------------+
15338 | string | str |
15339 +---------------------+-----------------+
15340 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15341 +---------------------+-----------------+
15342
15343Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15344matching method, see below.
15345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15347 - boolean
15348 - integer or integer range
15349 - IP address / network
15350 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15351 - regular expression
15352 - hex block
15353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015354The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15355
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015356 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15357 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015359 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015360 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015361 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015362 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15365read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15366if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15367lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15368will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15369beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15370a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15371lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15372exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15373
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015374The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15375parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15376ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15377a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15378check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15379
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015380The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15381socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15382file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15385loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15386
15387 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15388
15389In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15390the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15391case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15392as well.
15393
15394The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15395sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15396do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15397methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15398is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015399obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15401default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15402that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15403string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15404
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015405The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15406By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15407string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15408resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15409server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015410waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015411flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15412function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15415sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15416be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015417
15418 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15419 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15421 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15422 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15423 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015424
15425 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15426 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015428
15429 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015431
15432 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015434
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015435 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015436 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15437
15438 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15439 binary or string samples.
15440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15442 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15445 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15446 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15449 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15452 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15455 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15458 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015459 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15462 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15463 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015464
15465For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15466request, it is possible to do :
15467
15468 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15469
15470In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15471buffer, one would use the following acl :
15472
15473 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15474
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015475On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15476possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15477
15478 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15481criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15482method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15483to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15484criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15485the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015488the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15489For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15492 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15493 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15494 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015495
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015496
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015497The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15498types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15499combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15500brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15501default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503 +-------------------------------------------------+
15504 | Input sample type |
15505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015506 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15508 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015510 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015512 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015514 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015516 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015518 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015520 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015522 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015524 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015526 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015528 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015530 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15532 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015534
15535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155367.1.1. Matching booleans
15537------------------------
15538
15539In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15540Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15541When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15542that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15543
15544Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15545return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15546"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155497.1.2. Matching integers
15550------------------------
15551
15552Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15553enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15554to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15555
15556Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15557matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15558lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015559
15560For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15561unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15562representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15563
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015564As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15565two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15566instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15567ranges and operators.
15568
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015569For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015570operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15571Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15572of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015574Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015575
15576 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15577 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15578 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15579 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15580 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015582For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015583
15584 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15585
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015586This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15587
15588 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155917.1.3. Matching strings
15592-----------------------
15593
15594String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15595different forms :
15596
15597 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015598 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599
15600 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015601 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602
15603 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15604 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15605
15606 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15607 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15608
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015609 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15611 matches.
15612
15613 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15614 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15615 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015616
15617String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15618exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15619characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15620string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15621to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015622before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015623
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015624Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15625(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15626Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15627
15628Example:
15629 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15630 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156337.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15634---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015635
15636Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15637they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15638possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15639passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15640the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015641the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15642match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015643
15644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156457.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15646-------------------------------------
15647
15648It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15649not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15650a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15651to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15652digits may be used upper or lower case.
15653
15654Example :
15655 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15656 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15657
15658
156597.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15660---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015661
15662IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15663netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15664within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015665host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015666difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15667at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15668does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15669parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015670
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015671The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15672abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15673
15674 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15675 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15676 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15677 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15678 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15679 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15680 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15681 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15682
15683Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15684192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15685
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015686IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15687Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15688trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15689IPv6 patterns.
15690
15691HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15692following situations :
15693 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15694 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15695 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15696 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15697 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15698 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15699 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15700 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15701 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15702 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704
157057.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15706----------------------------------
15707
15708Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15709combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15710
15711 - AND (implicit)
15712 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15713 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15720indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15723"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15724requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15725is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15726
15727 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015728 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15729 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15730 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731
15732To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15733and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15734
15735 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15736 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15737 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15738 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015740 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15742 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15743 use_backend www if host_www
15744
15745It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15746expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15747be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15748the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15749
15750 The following rule :
15751
15752 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015753 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754
15755 Can also be written that way :
15756
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015757 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758
15759It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15760to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15761simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15762sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15763good use is the following :
15764
15765 With named ACLs :
15766
15767 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15768 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15769 monitor fail if site_dead
15770
15771 With anonymous ACLs :
15772
15773 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15774
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015775See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15776keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777
15778
157797.3. Fetching samples
15780---------------------
15781
15782Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15783against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15784sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15785ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15786of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15787available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15788
15789This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15790Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15791compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15792deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15793
15794The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15795matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15796method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15797indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15798
15799As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15800when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15801mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15802the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15803ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15804
15805Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15806multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15807when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015808incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15809are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15811all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15812
15813Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15814 - name
15815 - name(arg1)
15816 - name(arg1,arg2)
15817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015818
158197.3.1. Converters
15820-----------------
15821
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015822Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15823of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15824is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15825was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015826has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015827unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15828
15829These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15830sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15831the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015832support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015834A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15835support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15836supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15837(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15838bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015841
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001584251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15843 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15844 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15845 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15846 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15847 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15848
15849 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015850 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15851 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015852 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15853 frontend http-in
15854 bind *:8081
15855 default_backend servers
15856 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15857 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15858
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015859add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015860 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015861 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015862 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15863 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015864 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015865 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15866 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15867 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015869 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015870 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015872aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15873 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15874 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15875 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15876 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15877 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15878 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15879
15880 Example:
15881 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15882 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15883
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015884and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015885 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015886 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015887 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15888 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015889 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015890 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15891 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15892 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15893 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015894 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015895 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015896
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015897b64dec
15898 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15899 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015900 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15901 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015902
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015903base64
15904 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015906 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15907 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015908
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015909bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015910 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015911 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015912 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015913 presence of a flag).
15914
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015915bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15916 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15917 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015918 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015919
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015920concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15921 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15922 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15923 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15924 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15925 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15926 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15927 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15928 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15929 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15930 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015931 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015932 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015933 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15934 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015935
15936 Example:
15937 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15938 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15939 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015940 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015941 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15942
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015943cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015944 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15945 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015946
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015947crc32([<avalanche>])
15948 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15949 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15950 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15951 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15952 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15953 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15954 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15955 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15956 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15957 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015958 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15959
15960crc32c([<avalanche>])
15961 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15962 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15963 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15964 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15965 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15966 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15967 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15968 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015969
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015970cut_crlf
15971 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15972 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15973 updated.
15974
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015975da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015976 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15977 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15978 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15979 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015980 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015981 configuration language.
15982
15983 Example:
15984 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015985 bind *:8881
15986 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015987 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015988
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015989debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15990 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15991 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15992 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15993 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15994 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15995 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15996 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15997 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15998 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15999 printable sample types.
16000
16001 Example:
16002 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016003
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016004digest(<algorithm>)
16005 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16006 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16007
16008 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16009 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16010
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016011div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016012 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16013 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016014 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016015 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16016 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16019 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16020 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16021 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016022 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016023 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016024
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016025djb2([<avalanche>])
16026 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16027 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16028 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16029 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16030 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16031 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16032 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016033 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16034 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016035
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016036even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016037 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016038 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16039
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016040field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16041 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16042 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16043 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16044 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16045 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16046 fields.
16047
16048 Example :
16049 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16050 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16051 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16052 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16053 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016054
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016055fix_is_valid
16056 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16057 Information eXchange):
16058
16059 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16060 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016061 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016062 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016063 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016064 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16065 checksum
16066
16067 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16068 the server can be parsed.
16069
16070 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16071 message, false if not.
16072
16073 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16074
16075 Example:
16076 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16077 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16078
16079fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16080 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16081 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16082 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16083 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016084 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016085 added.
16086
16087 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16088 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16089 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16090 fix_is_valid converter.
16091
16092 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16093
16094 Example:
16095 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16096 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16097 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16098 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16099 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16100
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016101hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016103 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016105 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016106
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016107hex2i
16108 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016109 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016110
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016111htonl
16112 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16113 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16114 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16115 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16116
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016117hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016118 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16119 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16120 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16121 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16122
16123 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16124 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16125
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016126http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016127 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16128 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016129 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16130 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16131 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16132 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16133 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16134 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16135 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16136 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016138iif(<true>,<false>)
16139 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16140 string otherwise.
16141
16142 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016143 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016144
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016145in_table(<table>)
16146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16148 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016149 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016150 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16151
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016152ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016153 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016154 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016155 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16156 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16157 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16158 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16159 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016160
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016161json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016162 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016163 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016164 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016165 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16166 of errors:
16167 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16168 bytes, ...)
16169 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16170 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16171
16172 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16173 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16174 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16175 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16176 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16177 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016178 - "ascii" : never fails;
16179 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16180 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016181 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016182 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016183 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16184 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16185
16186 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016187 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016188
16189 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016190 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016191 capture request header user-agent len 150
16192 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016193
16194 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16195 GET / HTTP/1.0
16196 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16197
16198 Output log:
16199 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16200
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016201json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16202 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16203 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16204 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16205 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16206
16207 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16208 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16209
16210 Example:
16211 # get a integer value from the request body
16212 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16213 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16214
16215 # get a key with '.' in the name
16216 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16217 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16218
16219 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16220 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16221
16222 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16223 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16224
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016225language(<value>[,<default>])
16226 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16227 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16228 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16229 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16230 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16231 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16232 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16233 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16234 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016235 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016236 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16237 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016238
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016239 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016240
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016241 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16242 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016244 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16245 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16246 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16247 use_backend spanish if es
16248 use_backend french if fr
16249 use_backend english if en
16250 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016251
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016252length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016253 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16254 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16255 type. The result is of type integer.
16256
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016257lower
16258 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16259 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16260 type. The result is of type string.
16261
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016262ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16263 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16264 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16265 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16266 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16267 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16268 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16269
16270 Example :
16271
16272 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016273 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016274 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16275
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016276ltrim(<chars>)
16277 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16278 representation of the input sample.
16279
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016280map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16281map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16282map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16283 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16284 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16285 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16286 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16287 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16288 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16289 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16290 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016291
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016292 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16293 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16294 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016295
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016296 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016297 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016299 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16300 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16301 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16302 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016303 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16304 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016305 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16306 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16307 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16308 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16309 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16310 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16311 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16312 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016313 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16314 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16315 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016316 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16317 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16318 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16319 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16320 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016321
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016322 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16323 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16324 the corresponding match text.
16325
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016326 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16327 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16328 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16329 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16330 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016332 Example :
16333
16334 # this is a comment and is ignored
16335 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16336 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16337 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16338 | | | `---------- value
16339 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16340 | `---------------------------- key
16341 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16342
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016343mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016344 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16345 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016346 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016347 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016348 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016349 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16350 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16351 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16352 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016354 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016355
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016356mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016357 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16358 <packettype>.
16359 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16360 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16361 from.
16362 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16363 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16364 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16365
16366 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16367 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16368 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16369 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16370
16371 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16372 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16373 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16374 packets only):
16375 17: Session Expiry Interval
16376 33: Receive Maximum
16377 39: Maximum Packet Size
16378 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16379 25: Request Response Information
16380 23: Request Problem Information
16381 21: Authentication Method
16382 22: Authentication Data
16383 18: Will Delay Interval
16384 1: Payload Format Indicator
16385 2: Message Expiry Interval
16386 3: Content Type
16387 8: Response Topic
16388 9: Correlation Data
16389 Not supported yet:
16390 38: User Property
16391
16392 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16393 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16394 packets only):
16395 17: Session Expiry Interval
16396 33: Receive Maximum
16397 36: Maximum QoS
16398 37: Retain Available
16399 39: Maximum Packet Size
16400 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16401 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16402 31: Reason String
16403 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16404 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16405 42: Shared Subscription Available
16406 19: Server Keep Alive
16407 26: Response Information
16408 28: Server Reference
16409 21: Authentication Method
16410 22: Authentication Data
16411 Not supported yet:
16412 38: User Property
16413
16414 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16415 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16416 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16417 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16418
16419 Example:
16420
16421 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16422 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16423 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16424 if data_in_buffer
16425 # do the same as above
16426 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16427 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16428 if data_in_buffer
16429
16430mqtt_is_valid
16431 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16432
16433 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16434 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16435 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16436 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16437
16438 Example:
16439
16440 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16441 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16442
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016443mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016444 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016445 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16446 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016447 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016448 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016449 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016450 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16451 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16452 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16453 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016454 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016455 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016456
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016457nbsrv
16458 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16459 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16460 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16461 map lookup.
16462
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016463neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016464 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16465 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16466 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16467 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016468
16469not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016470 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016471 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016472 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016473 absence of a flag).
16474
16475odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016476 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016477 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16478
16479or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016480 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016481 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016482 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16483 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016484 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016485 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16486 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16487 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16488 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016490 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016491
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016492protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16493 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16494 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16495 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16496 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16497 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16498 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16499 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16500 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16501 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16502 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16503 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16504
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016505regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016506 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16507 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16508 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16509 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16510 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16511 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16512 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16513 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16514 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016515 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16516 of characters with other ones.
16517
16518 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16519 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16520 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16521 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16522 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16523 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016524
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016525 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016526
16527 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16528 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16529 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016530 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016531
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016532 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16533 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16534
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016535 # capture groups and backreferences
16536 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016537 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016538 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16539
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016540capture-req(<id>)
16541 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16542 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16543
16544 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016545 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16546 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016547
16548capture-res(<id>)
16549 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16550 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16551
16552 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016553 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16554 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016555
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016556rtrim(<chars>)
16557 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16558 of the input sample.
16559
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016560sdbm([<avalanche>])
16561 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16562 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16563 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16564 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16565 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16566 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16567 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016568 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16569 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016570
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016571secure_memcmp(<var>)
16572 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16573 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16574 match.
16575
16576 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16577 performed in constant time.
16578
16579 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16580 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16581
16582 Example :
16583
16584 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16585 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16586 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16587 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16588
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016589set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016590 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16591 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16592 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016596 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16598 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016599 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016600 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016601
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016602sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016603 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016604 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16605
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016606sha2([<bits>])
16607 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16608 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16609
16610 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16611 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16612
16613 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16614 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16615
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016616srv_queue
16617 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16618 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16619 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16620 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16621 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16622
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016623strcmp(<var>)
16624 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16625 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16626 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16627 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16628 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16629 shorter).
16630
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016631 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16632 strings in constant time.
16633
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016634 Example :
16635
16636 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16637 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16638 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16639
16640
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016641sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016642 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16643 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016644 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016645 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16646 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016647 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016648 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16649 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016650 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016654 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016655
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016656table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16657 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16658 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16659 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16660 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16661 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16662 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16663
16664
16665table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16666 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16667 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16668 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16669 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16670 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16671 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16672
16673table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16674 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16675 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016676 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016677 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16678 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16679
16680table_conn_cur(<table>)
16681 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16682 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16683 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16684 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16685 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16686
16687table_conn_rate(<table>)
16688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16691 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16692 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16693
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016694table_gpt0(<table>)
16695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16697 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16698 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16699 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16700
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016701table_gpc0(<table>)
16702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16704 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16705 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16706 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16707
16708table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16712 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16713 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16714 sample fetch keyword.
16715
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016716table_gpc1(<table>)
16717 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16718 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16719 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16720 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16721 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16722
16723table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16724 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16725 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16726 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16727 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16728 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16729 sample fetch keyword.
16730
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016731table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16732 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16733 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016735 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16736 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16737
16738table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16739 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16740 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16741 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16742 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16743 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16744 keyword.
16745
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016746table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16750 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16751 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16752
16753table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16754 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16755 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16756 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16757 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16758 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16759 keyword.
16760
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016761table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16762 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16763 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016764 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016765 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16766 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16767
16768table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16769 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16770 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16771 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16772 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16773 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16774 keyword.
16775
16776table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16777 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16778 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016779 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016780 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16781 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16782 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16783 keyword.
16784
16785table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16786 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16787 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016788 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016789 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16790 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16791 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16792 keyword.
16793
16794table_server_id(<table>)
16795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16797 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16798 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16799 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16800 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16801
16802table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16803 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16804 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016805 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016806 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16807 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16808 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16809 keyword.
16810
16811table_sess_rate(<table>)
16812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16814 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16815 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16816 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16817 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16818 keyword.
16819
16820table_trackers(<table>)
16821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16824 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16825 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16826 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16827 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16828 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16829 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16830 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16831
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016832ub64dec
16833 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16834 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16835 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16836
16837 Example:
16838 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16839 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16840
16841ub64enc
16842 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16843
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016844upper
16845 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16846 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16847 type. The result is of type string.
16848
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016849url_dec([<in_form>])
16850 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16851 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16852 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16853 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16854 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16855 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016856
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016857url_enc([<enc_type>])
16858 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16859 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16860 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16861 optional argument is here for future changes.
16862
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016863ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016864 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016865 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16866 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16867 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016868 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16869 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16870 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16871 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016872 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016873 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16874 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016875
16876 Example:
16877 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16878 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16879
16880 message Point {
16881 int32 latitude = 1;
16882 int32 longitude = 2;
16883 }
16884
16885 message PPoint {
16886 Point point = 59;
16887 }
16888
16889 message Rectangle {
16890 // One corner of the rectangle.
16891 PPoint lo = 48;
16892 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16893 PPoint hi = 49;
16894 }
16895
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016896 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16897 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16898 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016899
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016900 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16901 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016902 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016903 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16904
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016905 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016906
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016907 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016908
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016909 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16910 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16911 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016912
16913 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16914 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16915 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16916
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016917 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16918 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16919 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016920
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016921
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016922unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016923 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16924 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16925 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16926 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16927 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16928 response),
16929 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16930 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16931 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16932 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16933
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016934utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16935 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16936 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16937 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16938 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16939 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16940 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16941
16942 Example :
16943
16944 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016945 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016946 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16947
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016948word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16949 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16950 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16951 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016952 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016953 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16954 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16955
16956 Example :
16957 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16958 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16959 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16960 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16961 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016962 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016963
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016964wt6([<avalanche>])
16965 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16966 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16967 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16968 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16969 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16970 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16971 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016972 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16973 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016974
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016975xor(<value>)
16976 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016977 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016978 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016979 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016980 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016981 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16982 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016983 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016984 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16985 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016986 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016987 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016988
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016989xxh3([<seed>])
16990 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16991 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16992 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16993 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16994 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16995 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16996 considered as cryptographically secure.
16997
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016998xxh32([<seed>])
16999 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17000 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17001 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17002 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17003 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17004 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17005 as cryptographically secure.
17006
17007xxh64([<seed>])
17008 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17009 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17010 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17011 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17012 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17013 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17014 as cryptographically secure.
17015
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017018--------------------------------------------
17019
17020A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17021not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17022"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17023The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17024
17025always_false : boolean
17026 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17027 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17028
17029always_true : boolean
17030 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17031 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17032
17033avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017034 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017035 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17036 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17037 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17038 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17039 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17040 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17041 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17042 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17043 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17044 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17045 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17046 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17047 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017049be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017050 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17051 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17052 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17053 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017054 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17055
17056be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17057 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17058 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17059 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17060 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17061 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017062 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17063 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017064
17065 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17066 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17067 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017069be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17071 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17072 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017073 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017074 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17075 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017076
17077 Example :
17078 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17079 backend dynamic
17080 mode http
17081 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17082 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017083
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017085 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17086 of the string.
17087
17088bool(<bool>) : bool
17089 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17090 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017092connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017094 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017095 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17096 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017097
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017098 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017099 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017100 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17101
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017102 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17103 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017104
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017105 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017106 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017108 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017109 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017110 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017111 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017113 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17114 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017115 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017116 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017117
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017118cpu_calls : integer
17119 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17120 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17121 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17122 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17123 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17124 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17125
17126cpu_ns_avg : integer
17127 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17128 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17129 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17130 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17131 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17132 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17133 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17134 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17135 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17136 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17137 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17138
17139cpu_ns_tot : integer
17140 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17141 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17142 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17143 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17144 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17145 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17146 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17147 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17148 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17149 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17150 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17151 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17152 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17153
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017154date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017155 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017156
17157 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17158 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17159 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017160 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17161
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017162 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17163 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17164 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17165 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17166 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17167
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017168 Example :
17169
17170 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17171 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017172
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017173 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17174 # millisecond granularity
17175 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17176
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017177date_us : integer
17178 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17179 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17180 from the same timeval structure.
17181
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017182distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17183 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17184 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17185 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17186 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17187 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17188 list of supported tokens.
17189
17190distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17191 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17192 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17193 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17194 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17195 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17196 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17197 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17198 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17199 supported tokens.
17200
17201 Example :
17202 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17203 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17204 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17205 # send large files to the big farm
17206 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17207
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017208env(<name>) : string
17209 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17210 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17211 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17212 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17213 certain way.
17214
17215 Examples :
17216 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17217 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17218
17219 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17220 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017222fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17223 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017224 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17225 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17227 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017228 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17230 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017231
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017232fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17233 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17234 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17235 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17239 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17240 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17241 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17242 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17243 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17244 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17245 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017246
17247 Example :
17248 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17249 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17250 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17251 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17252 frontend mail
17253 bind :25
17254 mode tcp
17255 maxconn 100
17256 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17257 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17258 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17259 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017260
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017261hostname : string
17262 Returns the system hostname.
17263
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017264int(<integer>) : signed integer
17265 Returns a signed integer.
17266
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017267ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17268 Returns an ipv4.
17269
17270ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17271 Returns an ipv6.
17272
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017273lat_ns_avg : integer
17274 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17275 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17276 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17277 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17278 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17279 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17280 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17281 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17282 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017283 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17284 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17285 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17286 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17287 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17288 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017289
17290lat_ns_tot : integer
17291 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17292 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17293 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17294 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17295 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17296 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17297 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17298 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17299 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017300 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17301 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17302 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17303 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17304 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017305 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17306 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17307 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17308 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17309 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17310 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17311
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017312meth(<method>) : method
17313 Returns a method.
17314
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017315nbproc : integer
17316 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17317 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17318 and debugging purposes.
17319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17322 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17323 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017324 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17325 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17326 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017327
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017328prio_class : integer
17329 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17330 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17331 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17332
17333prio_offset : integer
17334 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17335 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17336 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17337 set-priority-offset".
17338
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017339proc : integer
17340 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17341 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17342 debugging purposes.
17343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017345 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17346 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17347 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17349 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17350 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17351 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17352 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17353
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017354rand([<range>]) : integer
17355 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17356 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17357 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17358 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17359 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17360
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017361uuid([<version>]) : string
17362 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17363 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17364 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17367 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17368 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17369 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17370 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17371 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017372 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17373 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17374
17375srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17376 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17377 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17378 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17379 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17380 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17381 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17382 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17383
17384 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17385 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017386
17387srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17388 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17389 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17390 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017391 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17393 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17394 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17395
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017396srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17397 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17398 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17399 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17400 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17401 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17402 fetch methods.
17403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017404srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17405 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17406 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017407 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017408 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17409 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017410 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411 overloading servers).
17412
17413 Example :
17414 # Redirect to a separate back
17415 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17416 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17417 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17418
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017419srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017420 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17421 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17422 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17423
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017424srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017425 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17426 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17427 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17428
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017429srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017430 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17431 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17432 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17433
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017434stopping : boolean
17435 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17436 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17437 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17438
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017439str(<string>) : string
17440 Returns a string.
17441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17443 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17444 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17445
17446table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17447 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17448 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17449 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17450
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017451thread : integer
17452 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17453 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17454 and debugging purposes.
17455
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017456var(<var-name>) : undefined
17457 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017458 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17459 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017460 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017461 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17462 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017463 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017464 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17465 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017466 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017467 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174697.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470----------------------------------
17471
17472The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17473closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17474methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17475sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17476TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017477the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17478counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017479"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17480used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17481can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17482Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17483table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17484tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17485currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017487bc_dst : ip
17488 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17489 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17490 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17491 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17492
17493bc_dst_port : integer
17494 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17495 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17496
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017497bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017498 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17499 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17500 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17501
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017502bc_src : ip
17503 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17504 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17505 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17506 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17507
17508bc_src_port : integer
17509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17510 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017512be_id : integer
17513 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017514 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17515 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017516
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017517be_name : string
17518 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017519 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17520 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017521
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017522be_server_timeout : integer
17523 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17524 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17525 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17526
17527be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17528 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17529 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17530 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17531
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017532cur_server_timeout : integer
17533 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17534 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17535 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17536
17537cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17538 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17539 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17540 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542dst : ip
17543 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17544 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17545 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17546 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017547 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17548 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17549 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17550 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17551 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17552 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553
17554dst_conn : integer
17555 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17556 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17557 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17558 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17559 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17560 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17561 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17562 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017563
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017564dst_is_local : boolean
17565 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17566 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17567 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17568 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017569 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017570 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17571 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17572 it only once per connection.
17573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574dst_port : integer
17575 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17576 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17577 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17578 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17579 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17580 an HTTP header.
17581
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017582fc_http_major : integer
17583 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17584 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17585 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17586
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017587fc_pp_authority : string
17588 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17589 if any.
17590
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017591fc_pp_unique_id : string
17592 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17593 if any.
17594
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017595fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17596 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17597 header.
17598
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017599fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17600 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17601 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17602 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17603 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17604 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17605 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17606
17607fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17608 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17609 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17610 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17611 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17612 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17613 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17614
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017615fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017616 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17617 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17618 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17619 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17620
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017621fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017622 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17623 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17624 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17625 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17626
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017627fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017628 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17629 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17630 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17631 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17632
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017633fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017634 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17635 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17636 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17637 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17638
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017639fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017640 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17641 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17642 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17643 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17644
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017645fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017646 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17647 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17648 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17649 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17650
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017651fe_defbe : string
17652 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17653 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655fe_id : integer
17656 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017657 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017658 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17659
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017660fe_name : string
17661 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17662 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17663 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17664
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017665fe_client_timeout : integer
17666 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17667 current frontend.
17668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017669sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017670sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17671sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17672sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017673 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17674 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17675 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017677sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017678sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17679sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17680sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017681 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17682 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17683 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17684
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017685sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017686sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17687sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17688sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017689 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17690 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017691 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17692 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17693 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017694
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017695 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017696 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17697 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017698 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17699 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17700 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017701 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17702 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17703
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017704sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17705sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17706sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17707sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17708 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17709 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17710 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17711 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17712 when a first ACL was verified.
17713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017714sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017715sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17716sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17717sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017718 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017719 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17720
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017721sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017722sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17723sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17724sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017725 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17726 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17727 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017729sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017730sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17731sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17732sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017733 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17734 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17735 See also src_conn_rate.
17736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017737sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017738sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17739sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17740sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017741 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017742 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017743
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017744sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17745sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17746sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17747sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17748 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17749 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17750
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017751sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17752sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17753sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17754sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17755 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17756 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17757
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017758sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017759sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17760sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17761sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017762 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17763 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17764 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017765 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17766 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17767 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017768
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017769sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17770sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17771sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17772sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17773 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17774 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17775 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17776 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17777 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17778 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017780sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017781sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17782sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17783sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017784 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017785 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17786 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017788sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017789sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17790sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17791sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017792 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17793 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17794 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17795 src_http_err_rate.
17796
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017797sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17798sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17799sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17800sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17801 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17802 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17803 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17804
17805sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17806sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17807sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17808sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17809 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17810 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17811 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17812 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17813
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017814sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017815sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17816sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17817sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017818 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017819 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17820 src_http_req_cnt.
17821
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017822sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017823sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17824sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17825sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017826 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17827 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17828 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17829 src_http_req_rate.
17830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017831sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017832sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17833sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17834sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017835 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017836 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17837 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17838 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17839 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017840
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017841 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017842 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17843 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017844 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17845
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017846sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17847sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17848sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17849sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17850 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17851 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17852 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17853 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17854 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17855
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017856sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017857sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17858sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17859sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017860 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17861 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17862 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017863
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017864sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017865sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17866sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17867sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017868 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17869 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17870 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017872sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017873sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17874sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17875sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017876 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017877 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17878 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17879 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017880 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017881 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017883sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017884sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17885sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17886sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017887 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17888 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17889 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17890 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17891 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017892 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017894sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017895sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17896sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17897sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017898 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17899 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17900 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017902sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017903sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17904sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17905sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017906 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17907 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017908 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017909 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17910 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017911 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17912 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17913 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017915so_id : integer
17916 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17917 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17918 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017919
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017920so_name : string
17921 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17922 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17923 strings instead of integers.
17924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017926 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17928 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17929 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017930 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17931 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17932 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017933 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17934 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17935 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17936 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17937 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17938 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17939 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017940
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017941 Example:
17942 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17943 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17946 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17947 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17948 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017949 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17952 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17953 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017954 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017955 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017957src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17958 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17959 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17960 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17961 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17962 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17963 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017964
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017965 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017966 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17967 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17968 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17969 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017970 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017971 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17972 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017974src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17975 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17976 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17977 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17978 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17979 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17980 was verified.
17981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017985 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017986 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017989 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017990 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17991 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017992 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17995 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17996 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17997 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017998 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018000src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018001 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018002 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018003 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018004 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018005
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018006src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18007 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18008 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18009 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18010 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18011
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018012src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18013 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18014 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18015 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18016 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018018src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018019 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018021 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18022 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018023 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18024 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18025 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018026
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018027src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18028 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18029 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18030 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18031 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18032 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18033 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18034 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018036src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018037 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018039 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018040 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018041 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18044 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18045 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18046 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18047 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018048 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018049
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018050src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18051 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18052 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018053 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018054 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18055 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18056
18057src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18058 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18059 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18060 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18061 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18062 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18063 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018065src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018066 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18068 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018069 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18072 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18073 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18074 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018075 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018076 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18079 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18080 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18081 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018082 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18084 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018085
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018086 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018087 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018088 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018089 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018090
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018091src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18092 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18093 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18094 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18095 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18096 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18097 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18098
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018099src_is_local : boolean
18100 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18101 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18102 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18103 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018104 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018105 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18106 once per connection.
18107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018108src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018109 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18110 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18111 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18112 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18113 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018116 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18117 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18118 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18119 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18120 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018122src_port : integer
18123 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18124 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18125 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18126 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018129 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018130 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18131 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18132 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018133 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18136 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18137 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18138 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18139 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018140 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18143 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18144 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18145 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18146 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18147 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18148 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18149 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18150 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018151
18152 Example :
18153 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18154 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18155 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18156 listen ssh
18157 bind :22
18158 mode tcp
18159 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018160 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018162 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018164srv_id : integer
18165 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18166 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018167 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018168
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018169srv_name : string
18170 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18171 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018172 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181747.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18178closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18179when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18180usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018181future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018182
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001818351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18184 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18185 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18186 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18187 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18188 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18189
18190 Example :
18191 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18192 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18193 # the request.
18194 frontend http-in
18195 bind *:8081
18196 default_backend servers
18197 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18198 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18199
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018200ssl_bc : boolean
18201 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18202 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018203 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18204 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018205
18206ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18207 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018208 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18209 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018210
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018211ssl_bc_alpn : string
18212 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18213 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018214 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018215 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18216 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18217 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18218 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18219 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018220 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18221 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018222
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018223ssl_bc_cipher : string
18224 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018225 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18226 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018227
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018228ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18229 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18230 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18231 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018232 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018233
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018234ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18235 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18236 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018237 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18238 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018239
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018240ssl_bc_npn : string
18241 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18242 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018243 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018244 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18245 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18246 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18247 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018248 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18249 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018250
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018251ssl_bc_protocol : string
18252 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018253 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18254 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018255
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018256ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018257 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018258 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018259 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18260 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018261
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018262ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18263 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18264 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18265 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018266 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018267
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018268ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18269 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18270 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018271 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18272 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018273
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018274ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18275 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18277 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018278 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018279
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018280ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18281 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018282 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18283 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18286 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18287 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18288 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18289 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18290 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18293 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18294 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18295 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18296 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018297
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018298ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018299 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18300 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18301 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018302 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018303 does not support resumed sessions.
18304
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018305ssl_c_der : binary
18306 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18307 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18308 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310ssl_c_err : integer
18311 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18312 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18313 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18314 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18315 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018316
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018317ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18319 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18320 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18321 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18322 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18323 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18324 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18325 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018326 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18327 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18328 LDAP v3.
18329 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18330 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332ssl_c_key_alg : string
18333 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18334 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18335 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337ssl_c_notafter : string
18338 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18339 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18340 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342ssl_c_notbefore : string
18343 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18344 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18345 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018346
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018347ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18349 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18350 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18351 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18352 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18353 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18354 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18355 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018356 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18357 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18358 LDAP v3.
18359 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18360 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362ssl_c_serial : binary
18363 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18364 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18365 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18368 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18369 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18370 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018371 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18372 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18373
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018374 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018375 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18378 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18379 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18380 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382ssl_c_used : boolean
18383 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18384 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386ssl_c_verify : integer
18387 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18388 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18389 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18390 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392ssl_c_version : integer
18393 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18394 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018395
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018396ssl_f_der : binary
18397 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18398 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18399 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18400
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018401ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18403 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18404 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18405 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018406 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18408 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18409 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018410 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18411 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18412 LDAP v3.
18413 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18414 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416ssl_f_key_alg : string
18417 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18418 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18419 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421ssl_f_notafter : string
18422 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18423 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18424 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426ssl_f_notbefore : string
18427 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18428 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18429 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018430
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018431ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18433 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18434 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18435 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18436 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18437 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18438 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18439 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018440 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18441 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18442 LDAP v3.
18443 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18444 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018446ssl_f_serial : binary
18447 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18448 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18449 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018450
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018451ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18452 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18453 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18454 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18457 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18458 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18459 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461ssl_f_version : integer
18462 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18463 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18464
18465ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018466 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18467 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18468 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018470 Example :
18471 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18472 listen http-https
18473 bind :80
18474 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18475 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18476
18477ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18478 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18479 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18480
18481ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018482 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18484 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18485 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18486 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18487 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18488 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18489 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18490 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492ssl_fc_cipher : string
18493 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18494 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018495
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018496ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18497 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18498 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018499 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018500
18501ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18502 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18503 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018504 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018505
18506ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18507 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18508 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18509 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018510 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018511 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018512
18513ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18514 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18515 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018516 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018517
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018518ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18519 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18520 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18521 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18522
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018523ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18524 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18525 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18526 transport layer.
18527 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18528 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18529 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18530 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18531
18532ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18533 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18534 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18535 transport layer.
18536 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18537 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18538 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18539 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18540
18541ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18542 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18543 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18544 transport layer.
18545 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18546 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18547 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18548 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18549
18550ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18551 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18552 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18553 transport layer.
18554 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18555 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18556 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18557 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18558
18559ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18560 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18561 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18562 transport layer.
18563 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18564 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18565 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18566 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018568ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018569 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18570 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018571 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18572 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18573 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18574 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018575
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018576ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18577 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18578 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18579 wait until the handshake happened.
18580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018581ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18582 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018583 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18584 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018585 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018586 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018587
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018588ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018589 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018590 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18591 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018594 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18596 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18597 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18598 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18599 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18600 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18601 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603ssl_fc_protocol : string
18604 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18605 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018606
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018607ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018608 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018609 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18610 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018611
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018612ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18613 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18614 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18615 transport layer.
18616 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18617 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18618 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18619 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18620
18621ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18622 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18623 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18624 transport layer.
18625 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18626 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18627 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18628 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18629
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018630ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18631 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18632 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18633 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18636 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18637 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18638 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18639 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018640
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018641ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18642 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18643 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18644 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18645 BoringSSL.
18646
18647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648ssl_fc_sni : string
18649 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18650 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18651 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18652 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18653 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18654
18655 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18656 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18657 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018658 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018659 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18663 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18666 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18667 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018668
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018669ssl_s_der : binary
18670 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18671 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18672 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18673
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018674ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18675 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18676 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18677 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018678 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018679 does not support resumed sessions.
18680
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018681ssl_s_key_alg : string
18682 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18683 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18684 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18685
18686ssl_s_notafter : string
18687 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18688 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18689 transport layer.
18690
18691ssl_s_notbefore : string
18692 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18693 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18694 transport layer.
18695
18696ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18697 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18698 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18699 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18700 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18701 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18702 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018703 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18704 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018705 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18706 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18707 LDAP v3.
18708 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18709 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18710
18711ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18712 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18713 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18714 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18715 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18716 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18717 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018718 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18719 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018720 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18721 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18722 LDAP v3.
18723 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18724 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18725
18726ssl_s_serial : binary
18727 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18728 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18729 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18730
18731ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18732 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18733 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18734 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18735
18736ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18737 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18738 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18739 layer.
18740
18741ssl_s_version : integer
18742 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18743 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018744
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018748Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18749sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18750only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18751For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18752be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18753can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18754sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18755for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18756content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018757
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018758Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18759 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18760 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18761 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18762 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18763 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18764 sample expression). So be careful.
18765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018766payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018767 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18769 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018771payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18772 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018773 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018776req.len : integer
18777req_len : integer (deprecated)
18778 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18779 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18780 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18781 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18782 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18783 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18784 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18785 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18788 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018789 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18790 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18791 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18792 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018794 ACL alternatives :
18795 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18798 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18799 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18800 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18801 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803 ACL alternatives :
18804 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808req.proto_http : boolean
18809req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18810 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18811 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18812 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18813 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18814 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18815 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18816 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818 Example:
18819 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18820 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18821 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018822 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018824req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18825rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18826 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18827 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18828 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18829 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18830 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18831 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18832 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18835 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18836 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18837 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18838 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18839 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841 ACL derivatives :
18842 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844 Example :
18845 listen tse-farm
18846 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18847 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18848 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18849 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18850 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18851 persist rdp-cookie
18852 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18853 # This is only useful makes sense if
18854 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18855 stick-table type string size 204800
18856 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18857 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18858 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18861 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18864rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18865 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18866 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18867 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18868 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018870 ACL derivatives :
18871 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018872
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018873req.ssl_alpn : string
18874 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18875 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18876 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18877 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18878 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18879 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018880 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018881
18882 Examples :
18883 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18884 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18885 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018886 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018887 default_backend bk_default
18888
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018889req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18890 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18891 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018892 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18893 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18894 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18895 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18896 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018898req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18899req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18900 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18901 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18902 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18903 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18904 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18905 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18906 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018908req.ssl_sni : string
18909req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18910 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18911 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18912 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18913 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18914 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018915 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18916 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18917 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18918 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18919 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18920 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18921 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18922 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18923 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018925 ACL derivatives :
18926 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018928 Examples :
18929 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18930 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18931 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18932 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18933 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018934
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018935req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18936 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18937 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18938 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18939 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18940 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18941 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18942 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18943 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18944 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946req.ssl_ver : integer
18947req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18948 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18949 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18950 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18951 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18952 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18953 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18954 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018955 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958 ACL derivatives :
18959 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018960
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018961res.len : integer
18962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18963 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18964 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18965 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18966 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18967 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18968 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018969 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018971res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18972 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018973 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018974 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018975 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018976 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18979 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18980 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18981 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018982 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18983 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018985 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018986
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018987res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18988rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18989 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18990 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18991 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18992 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18993 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18994 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18995 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997wait_end : boolean
18998 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18999 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019000 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19002 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019003 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019004 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19005 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019007 Examples :
19008 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19009 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19010 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19013 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19014 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19015 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19016 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19017 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19018 tcp-request content reject
19019
19020
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190217.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022--------------------------------------
19023
19024It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19025This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19026data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19027its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19028HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19029content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19030to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19031more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19032response are indexed.
19033
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019034Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19035 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19036 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19037 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19038 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19039 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19040 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042base : string
19043 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19044 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19045 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19046 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19047 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19048 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19049 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19050 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19051
19052 ACL derivatives :
19053 base : exact string match
19054 base_beg : prefix match
19055 base_dir : subdir match
19056 base_dom : domain match
19057 base_end : suffix match
19058 base_len : length match
19059 base_reg : regex match
19060 base_sub : substring match
19061
19062base32 : integer
19063 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19064 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19065 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019066 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19067 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19068 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019069
19070base32+src : binary
19071 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19072 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19073 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19074 per-URL counters.
19075
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019076baseq : string
19077 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19078 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19079 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19080 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19081
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019082capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19083 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19084 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19085 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19086
19087capture.req.method : string
19088 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19089 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19090 because it's allocated.
19091
19092capture.req.uri : string
19093 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19094 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19095 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19096 allocated.
19097
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019098capture.req.ver : string
19099 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19100 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19101 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19102
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019103capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19104 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19105 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19106 The first entry is an index of 0.
19107 See also: "capture response header"
19108
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019109capture.res.ver : string
19110 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19111 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19112 persistent flag.
19113
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019114req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019115 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19116 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19117 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019118
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019119req.body_param([<name>) : string
19120 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19121 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19122 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19123 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19124 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19125 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19126 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19127 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19128 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19129 given.
19130
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019131req.body_len : integer
19132 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19133 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019134 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19135 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019136
19137req.body_size : integer
19138 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019139 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19140 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142req.cook([<name>]) : string
19143cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19144 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19145 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19146 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19147 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19148 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19149 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19150 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19151 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19152
19153 ACL derivatives :
19154 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19155 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19156 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19157 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19158 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19159 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19160 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19161 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19164cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19165 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19166 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19169cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19170 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19171 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19172 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19173 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019175cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19176 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19177 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19178 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19179 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019180 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019181 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19182 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19183 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19184 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19187 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19188 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19189 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19190 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019191 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019193req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019194 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19195 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19196 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19197 with headers such as User-Agent.
19198
19199 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19200 found.
19201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19203 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19204 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019205 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019207req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19208 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19209 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019210 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19211 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019214 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19215 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19216 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19217 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19218 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19219 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19220 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19221
19222 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19223 found.
19224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19226 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19227 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019228 with -1 being the last one.
19229
19230 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19231 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019233 ACL derivatives :
19234 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19235 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19236 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19237 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19238 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19239 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19240 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19241 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19242
19243req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19244hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19245 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19246 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019247 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19248 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19249 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19250
19251 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19252 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19253 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19254
19255 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256
19257req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19258hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19259 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19260 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19261 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019262 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19263 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19264 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19265 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19266 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019267
19268 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19269
19270 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271
19272req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19273hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19274 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19275 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19276 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019277
19278 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19279
19280 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019282req.hdrs : string
19283 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19284 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19285 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19286 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19287
19288req.hdrs_bin : binary
19289 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19290 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19291 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19292 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19293 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19294 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19295
19296 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019297
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019298 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19299 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19302 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19303 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19304 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19305 basic auth is supported.
19306
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019307http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19308 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19309 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19310 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19311 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19313 basic auth is supported.
19314
19315 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019316 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19317 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19318 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19319 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019321http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019322 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19323 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19324 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019325
19326http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019327 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19328 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19329 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019330
19331http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019332 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19333 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19334 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019337 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19338 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19340 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342method : integer + string
19343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19344 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19345 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19346 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19347 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19348 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19349 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351 ACL derivatives :
19352 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019354 Example :
19355 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19356 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19357 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019359path : string
19360 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19361 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19362 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19363 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19364 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019365 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019366 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019368 ACL derivatives :
19369 path : exact string match
19370 path_beg : prefix match
19371 path_dir : subdir match
19372 path_dom : domain match
19373 path_end : suffix match
19374 path_len : length match
19375 path_reg : regex match
19376 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019377
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019378pathq : string
19379 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19380 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19381 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19382 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19383 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19384 result in both cases.
19385
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019386query : string
19387 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19388 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19389 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19390 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019391 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019392 which stops before the question mark.
19393
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019394req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19395 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19396 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19397 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19398 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400req.ver : string
19401req_ver : string (deprecated)
19402 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19403 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19404 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406 ACL derivatives :
19407 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019408
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019409res.body : binary
19410 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19411 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019412 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19413
19414 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019415
19416res.body_len : integer
19417 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19418 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019419 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19420
19421 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019422
19423res.body_size : integer
19424 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19425 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19426 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19427 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019428 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19429
19430 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019431
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019432res.cache_hit : boolean
19433 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19434 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19435
19436res.cache_name : string
19437 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19438 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19439 empty string.
19440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441res.comp : boolean
19442 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19443 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19444 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019446res.comp_algo : string
19447 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19448 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19449 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019451res.cook([<name>]) : string
19452scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19453 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19454 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019455 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19456
19457 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459 ACL derivatives :
19460 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19463scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19464 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19465 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019466 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19467
19468 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019470res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19471scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19472 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19473 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019474 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19475
19476 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019479 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19480 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19481
19482 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19483 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19484
19485 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19486
19487 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019490 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19491 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19492
19493 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19494 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19495
19496 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019498res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19499shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019500 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19501 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19502
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019503 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019504 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19505
19506 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508 ACL derivatives :
19509 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19510 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19511 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19512 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19513 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19514 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19515 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19516 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19517
19518res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19519shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019520 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19521 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19522
19523 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019524 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019525
19526 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19529shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019530 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19531 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19532
19533 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19534
19535 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019536
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019537res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19538 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19539 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19540 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019541 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19542
19543 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19546shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019547 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19548 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19549
19550 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19551
19552 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019553
19554res.hdrs : string
19555 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19556 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19557 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019558 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19559
19560 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019561
19562res.hdrs_bin : binary
19563 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19564 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19565 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19566 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19567 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19568 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19569 (length of 0 for both).
19570
19571 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19572
19573 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19574 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576res.ver : string
19577resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19578 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019579 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19580
19581 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019583 ACL derivatives :
19584 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019586set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19587 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19588 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019589 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019590 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019592 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19593 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019595status : integer
19596 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19597 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019598 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19599
19600 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019601
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019602unique-id : string
19603 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19604 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19605 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19606 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19607 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19608 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019610url : string
19611 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19612 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19613 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19614 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19615 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19616 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19617 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019619 ACL derivatives :
19620 url : exact string match
19621 url_beg : prefix match
19622 url_dir : subdir match
19623 url_dom : domain match
19624 url_end : suffix match
19625 url_len : length match
19626 url_reg : regex match
19627 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019629url_ip : ip
19630 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19631 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19632 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19633 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19634 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19635 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19636 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638url_port : integer
19639 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19640 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19641 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19642 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019643
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019644urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19645url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019646 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19647 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019648 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19649 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19650 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19651 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19653 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019654 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19655 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019657 ACL derivatives :
19658 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19659 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19660 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19661 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19662 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19663 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19664 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19665 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019666
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668 Example :
19669 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19670 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19671 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19672 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019673
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019674urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019675 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19676 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19677 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019678
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019679url32 : integer
19680 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19681 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19682 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19683 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19684 is an unsigned integer.
19685
19686url32+src : binary
19687 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19688 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19689 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19690
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019691
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200196927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019693---------------------------------------
19694
19695This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19696used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19697purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19698There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19699or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19700any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19701for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19702
19703internal.htx.data : integer
19704 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19705 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19706
19707internal.htx.free : integer
19708 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19709 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19710
19711internal.htx.free_data : integer
19712 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19713 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19714
19715internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019716 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19717 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19718 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019719
19720internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19721 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19722 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19723
19724internal.htx.size : integer
19725 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19726 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19727
19728internal.htx.used : integer
19729 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19730 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19731 direction.
19732
19733internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19734 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19735 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19736 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19737 of the special value :
19738 * head : The oldest inserted block
19739 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019740 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019741
19742internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19743 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19744 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19745 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19746 integer or one of the special value :
19747 * head : The oldest inserted block
19748 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019749 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019750
19751internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19752 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19753 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19754 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19755 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19756
19757 * head : The oldest inserted block
19758 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019759 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019760
19761internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19762 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19763 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19764 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19765 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19766
19767 * head : The oldest inserted block
19768 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019769 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019770
19771internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19772 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19773 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19774 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19775 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19776
19777 * head : The oldest inserted block
19778 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019779 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019780
19781internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19782 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19783 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19784 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19785 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19786
19787 * head : The oldest inserted block
19788 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019789 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019790
19791internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19792 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19793 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19794 it returns false.
19795
19796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200197977.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019798---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019800Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19801every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019802order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019804ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019805---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19806FALSE always_false never match
19807HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19808HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19809HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019810HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019811HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19812HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19813HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19814HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19815LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19816METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19817METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19818METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19819METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19820METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19821METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19822METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19823METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19824RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19825REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19826TRUE always_true always match
19827WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19828---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019829
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198318. Logging
19832----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019833
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019834One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19835provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19836very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19837provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19838state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019839to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019840headers.
19841
19842In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19843about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19844send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19845
19846 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19847 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19848 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19849 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19850 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019851 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019852 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853
19854The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19855allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19856as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19857while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19858real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19859delay.
19860
19861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198628.1. Log levels
19863---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019864
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019865TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019866source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019867HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19868in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19869track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19870syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19871about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019872
19873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198748.2. Log formats
19875----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019877HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019878and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19879slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19880options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019881
19882 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19883 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19884 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19885 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19886 extents.
19887
19888 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19889 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19890 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19891 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19892 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19893
19894 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19895 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19896 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19897 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19898 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19899
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019900 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19901 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19902 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19903 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19904
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019905 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19906
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019907Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19908specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19909field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19910servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19911always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19912identifier.
19913
19914Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19915 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19916 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19917 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19918 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19919
19920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199218.2.1. Default log format
19922-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019923
19924This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19925as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19926format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19927
19928 Example :
19929 listen www
19930 mode http
19931 log global
19932 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19933
19934 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19935 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19936 (www/HTTP)
19937
19938 Field Format Extract from the example above
19939 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19940 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19941 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19942 4 'to' to
19943 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19944 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19945
19946Detailed fields description :
19947 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19948 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19949 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19950 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19951 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19952 and processed the connection.
19953 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19954
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019955In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19956"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19957connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19958
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019959It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19960will eventually disappear.
19961
19962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199638.2.2. TCP log format
19964---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965
19966The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19967is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19968information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19969counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19970emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19971environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19972the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19973sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019974specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19975not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19976fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19977marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019978
19979 Example :
19980 frontend fnt
19981 mode tcp
19982 option tcplog
19983 log global
19984 default_backend bck
19985
19986 backend bck
19987 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19988
19989 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19990 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19991 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19992
19993 Field Format Extract from the example above
19994 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19995 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19996 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19997 4 frontend_name fnt
19998 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19999 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20000 7 bytes_read* 212
20001 8 termination_state --
20002 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20003 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20004
20005Detailed fields description :
20006 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020007 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20008 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20009 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020010 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020011 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020012 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020013
20014 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020015 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20016 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20017 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020018
20019 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20020 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20021 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020022 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20023 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20024 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20025 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026
20027 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20028 and processed the connection.
20029
20030 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20031 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20032 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20033 applications.
20034
20035 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20036 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20037 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20038 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20039 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20040
20041 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20042 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20043 See "Timers" below for more details.
20044
20045 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20046 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20047 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20048 "Timers" below for more details.
20049
20050 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020051 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020052 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20053 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20054 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20055 details.
20056
20057 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20058 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20059 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20060 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20061 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20062
20063 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20064 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20065 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20066 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20067 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20068 for more details.
20069
20070 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020071 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020072 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20073 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20074 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020075 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020076
20077 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20078 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20079 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20080 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20081 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20082 caused by a denial of service attack.
20083
20084 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20085 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20086 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20087 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20088 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20089 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20090 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20091 denial of service attack.
20092
20093 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20094 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20095 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20096 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20097 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20098 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20099 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20100 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20101 be processed than on other servers.
20102
20103 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20104 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20105 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20106 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20107 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20108 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20109 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20110 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20111 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20112 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20113 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20114 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20115 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20116
20117 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20118 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20119 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20120 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20121 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20122 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020123 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020124 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20125
20126 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20127 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20128 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20129 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20130 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20131 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020132 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020133 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20134 occurs.
20135
20136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201378.2.3. HTTP log format
20138----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020139
20140The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20141is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20142the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20143are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20144emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20145generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20146"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20147which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020148frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20149is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020150
20151Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20152slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20153with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20154
20155 Example :
20156 frontend http-in
20157 mode http
20158 option httplog
20159 log global
20160 default_backend bck
20161
20162 backend static
20163 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20164
20165 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20166 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20167 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020168 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020169
20170 Field Format Extract from the example above
20171 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20172 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020173 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174 4 frontend_name http-in
20175 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020176 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020177 7 status_code 200
20178 8 bytes_read* 2750
20179 9 captured_request_cookie -
20180 10 captured_response_cookie -
20181 11 termination_state ----
20182 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20183 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20184 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20185 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20186 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020188Detailed fields description :
20189 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020190 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20191 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20192 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020193 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020194 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020195 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020196
20197 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020198 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20199 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20200 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020202 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20203 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020204
20205 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20206 and processed the connection.
20207
20208 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20209 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20210 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20211
20212 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20213 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20214 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20215 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20216 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20217 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20218
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020219 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20220 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20221 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020222 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020223 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20224 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020225 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20226 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020227
20228 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20229 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020230 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020231
20232 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20233 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020234 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20235 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
20237 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20238 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20239 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20240 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20241 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020242 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20243 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020245 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20246 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20247 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20248 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20249 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20250 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20251 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020252 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253
20254 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20255 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20256 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20257
20258 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20259 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020260 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020261 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20262 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20263 overflowing.
20264
20265 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20266 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20267 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20268 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20269 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20270 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20271 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20272 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20273
20274 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20275 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20276 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20277 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20278 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20279 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20280 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20281 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20282
20283 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20284 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20285 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20286 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20287 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20288 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20289 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20290
20291 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020292 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020293 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20294 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20295 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020296 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020297 system.
20298
20299 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20300 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20301 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20302 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20303 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20304 caused by a denial of service attack.
20305
20306 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20307 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20308 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20309 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20310 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20311 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20312 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20313 denial of service attack.
20314
20315 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20316 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20317 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20318 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20319 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20320 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20321 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20322 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20323 processed than on other servers.
20324
20325 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20326 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20327 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20328 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20329 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20330 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20331 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20332 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20333 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20334 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20335 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20336 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20337 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20338
20339 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20340 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20341 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20342 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20343 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20344 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020345 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020346 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20347
20348 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20349 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20350 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20351 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20352 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20353 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020354 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020355 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20356 occurs.
20357
20358 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20359 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20360 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20361 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20362 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20363 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20364 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20365 cookies" below for more details.
20366
20367 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20368 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20369 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20370 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20371 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20372 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20373 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20374 and cookies" below for more details.
20375
20376 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20377 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20378 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20379 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20380 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20381 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20382 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20383 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20384
20385
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200203868.2.4. Custom log format
20387------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020388
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020389The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020390mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020392HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020393Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20394separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20395prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20396
20397Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20398variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020399("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020400
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020401If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020402as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020403less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20404the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20405
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020406Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20407"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20408delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20409preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020410
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020411Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20412'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20413https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20414such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20415
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020416Flags are :
20417 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020418 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020419 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20420 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020421
20422 Example:
20423
20424 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20425 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20426
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020427 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20428
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020429At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020431 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20432 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020433
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020434the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020436 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20437 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20438 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020439
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020440and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20441
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020442 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20443 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020444
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020445Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20446
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020447 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020448 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020449 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20450 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20451 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020452 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20453 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20454 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020455 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020456 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020457 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020458 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020459 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020460 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20461 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020462 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020463 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020464 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020465 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020466 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020467 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020468 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020469 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20470 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20471 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20472 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20473 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020474 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020475 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020476 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020477 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020478 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020479 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20480 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020481 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20482 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20483 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020484 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020485 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20486 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020487 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020488 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20489 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20490 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020491 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020492 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020493 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20494 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20495 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20496 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020497 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020498 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020499 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020500 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020501 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020502 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020503 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20504 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20505 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020506 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020507 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20508 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020509 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020510 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20511 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020512 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020513 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020514 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020515 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020516
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020517 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020518
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020519
205208.2.5. Error log format
20521-----------------------
20522
20523When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20524protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20525By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20526"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020527will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020528logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20529
20530The format looks like this :
20531
20532 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20533 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20534 Connection error during SSL handshake
20535
20536 Field Format Extract from the example above
20537 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20538 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20539 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20540 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20541 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20542
20543These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20544failures.
20545
20546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205478.3. Advanced logging options
20548-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020549
20550Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20551just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20552options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20553for more information about their usage.
20554
20555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205568.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20557------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020558
20559It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20560haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20561commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20562monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20563ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20564
20565 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20566 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20567 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20568 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20569
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020570 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20571 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020572
20573 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20574 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20575 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20576
20577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20579----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580
20581The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20582what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20583or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020584"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020585just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20586log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20587after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20588is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20589with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20590with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20591
20592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20594------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020595
20596Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20597for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20598"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20599retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20600raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20601a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20602file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20603you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20604"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20605
20606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20608--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020609
20610Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20611multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20612them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20613"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20614logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20615error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20616and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20617too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20618useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20619alternative.
20620
20621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206228.4. Timing events
20623------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020624
20625Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20626reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20627the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20628frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020629mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20630addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20631
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020632Timings events in HTTP mode:
20633
20634 first request 2nd request
20635 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20636 t tr t tr ...
20637 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20638 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20639 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20640 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020641 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020642 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20643
20644Timings events in TCP mode:
20645
20646 TCP session
20647 |<----------------->|
20648 t t
20649 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20650 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20651 |<------ Tt ------->|
20652
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020653 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020654 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020655 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20656 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20657 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020658 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020659 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20660 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20661 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20662 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020663
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020664 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20665 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20666 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020667 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20668 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20669 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20670 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20671 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20672 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020673
20674 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20675 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20676 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20677 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20678 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20679 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20680 request typed by hand during a test.
20681
20682 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20683 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020684 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020685 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20686 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20687 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20688 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020689
20690 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20691 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20692 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20693 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20694 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20695
20696 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20697 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20698 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20699 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20700 connection never established.
20701
20702 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20703 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20704 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20705 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20706 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20707 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20708 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20709 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20710 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20711 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20712 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20713
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020714 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20715 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20716 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20717 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20718 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20719 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20720
20721 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20722
20723 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20724 "Ta" can never be negative.
20725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020726 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20727 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020728 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20729 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020730 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020732 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020733
20734 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020735 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20736 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020737
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020738 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20739 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20740 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20741 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20742 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20743 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20744 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20745 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020747These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20748protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20749that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020750due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20751"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20752that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020753
20754Most common cases :
20755
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020756 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20757 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20758 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20759 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20760 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20761 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20762 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20763 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20764 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20765 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20766 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020767 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020768
20769 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20770 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20771 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20772 of ms on remote networks.
20773
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020774 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20775 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20776 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020777
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020778 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20779 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20780 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20781 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20782 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20783 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20784 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20785 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20786 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787
20788Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20789
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020790 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020791 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020792 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020794 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020795 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20796 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20797
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020798 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020799 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20800 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20801 flags.
20802
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020803 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20804 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020805 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20806 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20807 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20808 the client connection was maintained open.
20809
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020810 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020811 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020812 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020813 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20814
20815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208168.5. Session state at disconnection
20817-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020818
20819TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20820"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208212-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20822each of which has a special meaning :
20823
20824 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20825 session to terminate :
20826
20827 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20828
20829 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20830 server explicitly refused it.
20831
20832 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20833 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20834 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20835 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020836 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020837
20838 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20839 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020840
20841 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20842 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20843 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20844 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20845 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20846
20847 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20848 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20849 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20850 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20851 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20852
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020853 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20854 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20855
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020856 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20857 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20858 backup connections when going up.
20859
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020860 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20861
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020862 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20863 send or receive data.
20864
20865 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20866 send or receive data.
20867
20868 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20869 with nothing left in the buffers.
20870
20871 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20872
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020873 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020874 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20875
20876 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20877 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20878 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20879 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20880 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20881
20882 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20883 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20884
20885 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20886 server (HTTP only).
20887
20888 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20889
20890 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20891 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20892 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20893
20894 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20895 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20896 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20897
20898 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20899
20900 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20901 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20902
20903 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20904 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20905 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20906
20907 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20908 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020909 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20910 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020911
20912 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20913 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20914 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20915 another server.
20916
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020917 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020918 server.
20919
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020920 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20921 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20922 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20923 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20924
20925 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20926 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20927 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20928 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20929
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020930 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20931 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20932 "use-server" rule).
20933
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020934 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20935
20936 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20937 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20938
20939 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20940
20941 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20942 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20943 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20944
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020945 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20946 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020947 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020948 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20949 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020951 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20952
20953 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20954 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20955
20956 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20957
20958 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20959
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020960The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20961was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020962helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20963starvation, attacks, etc...
20964
20965The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20966alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20967easier finding and understanding.
20968
20969 Flags Reason
20970
20971 -- Normal termination.
20972
20973 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20974 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20975 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20976 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20977
20978 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20979 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20980 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20981 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20982 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20983 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20986 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020987 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020988
20989 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20990 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20991 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20992
20993 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20994 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20995 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20996 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20997 the server takes too long to respond.
20998
20999 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21000 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21001 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21002 long a time to respond.
21003
21004 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21005 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21006 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21007 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021008 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21009 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021010
21011 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21012 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21013 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21014 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21015 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021016 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021017 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21018 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21019 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21020 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21021 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21022 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21023 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21024 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021025 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021026 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21027 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21028 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021029
21030 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21031 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021032 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21033 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21034 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21035 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021037 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21038 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021040 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21042 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021043 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021044 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21045 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21046
21047 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21048 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21049 503 or 504 here.
21050
21051 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21052 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21053 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21054 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21055 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21056
21057 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21058 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021059 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021060 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21061 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21062
21063 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21064 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21065 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21066 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21067 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21068 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21069 between haproxy and the server.
21070
21071 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21072 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21073 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21074 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21075 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21076 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21077 solution is to fix the application.
21078
21079 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21080 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21081 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21082 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21083 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21084 external attacks.
21085
21086 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021087 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021088 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021089 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21090 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21091
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021092 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21093 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21094 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021095 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021096 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021098 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21099 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21100 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21101 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021102 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21103 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21104 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21105 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21106 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021107
21108 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21109 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21110 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21111 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21112
21113 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21114 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21115 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21116 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21117
21118 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21119 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21120 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21121 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021123The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21124persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21125important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21126re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21127
21128 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21129
21130 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21131 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21132 set on a GET request.
21133
21134 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21135 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021136 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021137 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21138
21139 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21140 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21141 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21142
21143 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21144 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21145 already got a cookie.
21146
21147 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21148 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21149 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21150 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21151 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21152
21153 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21154 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21155 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21156
21157 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21158 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21159 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21160
21161 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21162 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21163
21164 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21165 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21166 then advertised in the response.
21167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211698.6. Non-printable characters
21170-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021171
21172In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21173consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21174converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21175prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21176being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21177escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21178is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21179'}' when logging headers.
21180
21181Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21182issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21183containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21184
21185Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21186the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21187performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21188
21189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21191---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021192
21193Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21194achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021195section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021196cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21197the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21198the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021199locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021200not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21201user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21202a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21203wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21204
21205 Examples :
21206 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21207 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21208
21209 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21210 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21211
21212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21214---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215
21216Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21217proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21218the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21219server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21220
21221Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21222response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021223section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021224
21225It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021226time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21227appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021228are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21229and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21230follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21231request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21232in the logs.
21233
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021234As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21235frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21236an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21237
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021238 Example :
21239 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21240 listen proxy-out
21241 mode http
21242 option httplog
21243 option logasap
21244 log global
21245 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21246
21247 # log the name of the virtual server
21248 capture request header Host len 20
21249
21250 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21251 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21252
21253 # log the beginning of the referrer
21254 capture request header Referer len 20
21255
21256 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21257 capture response header Server len 20
21258
21259 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21260 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021262 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21264
21265 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21266 capture response header Via len 20
21267
21268 # log the URL location during a redirection
21269 capture response header Location len 20
21270
21271 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21272 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21273 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21274 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21275 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21276
21277 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21278 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21279 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21280 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021281 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021282
21283 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21284 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21285 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21286 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21287 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021288 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021289
21290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212918.9. Examples of logs
21292---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021293
21294These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21295them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21296reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21297
21298 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21299 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21300 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21301
21302 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21303 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21304
21305 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21306 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21307 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21308
21309 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21310 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21311
21312 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21313 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21314 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21315
21316 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021317 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021318 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21319 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21320
21321 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21322 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21323 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21324
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021325 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21326 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21327 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21328 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21329 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21330 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021331
21332 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021333 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021334
21335 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21336 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21337 Nothing was sent to any server.
21338
21339 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21340 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21341
21342 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21343 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021344 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021345 send a 408 return code to the client.
21346
21347 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21348 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21349
21350 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21351 5 seconds ("c----").
21352
21353 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21354 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021355 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021356
21357 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021358 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021359 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21360 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21361 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21362 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21363 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021364
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021365
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200213669. Supported filters
21367--------------------
21368
21369Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21370accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21371unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21372
21373See also : "filter"
21374
213759.1. Trace
21376----------
21377
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021378filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021379
21380 Arguments:
21381 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21382 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21383
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021384 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021385
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021386 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021387 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21388 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21389 amount of the parsed data.
21390
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021391 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021392
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021393This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21394callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21395information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21396filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21397
21398Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21399tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21400a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21401
21402
214039.2. HTTP compression
21404---------------------
21405
21406filter compression
21407
21408The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21409keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021410when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21411fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21412done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21413explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21414filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21415listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21416order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021417
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021418See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21419 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021420
21421
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214229.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21423--------------------------------------------
21424
21425filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21426
21427 Arguments :
21428
21429 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21430 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21431 parsed.
21432
21433 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21434 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21435 part must be placed in its own scope.
21436
21437The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21438external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021439streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021440exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21441also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21442
21443SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21444the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21445
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021446For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021447"doc/SPOE.txt".
21448
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214499.4. Cache
21450----------
21451
21452filter cache <name>
21453
21454 Arguments :
21455
21456 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21457
21458The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21459"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021460cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021461other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21462case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21463is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21464filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021465listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21466order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021467
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021468See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21469 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21470
21471
214729.5. Fcgi-app
21473-------------
21474
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021475filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021476
21477 Arguments :
21478
21479 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21480
21481The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21482request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21483reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21484used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21485implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21486used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21487fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21488used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21489order.
21490
21491See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21492 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21493
21494
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100214959.6. OpenTracing
21496----------------
21497
21498The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21499HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21500of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21501Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21502
21503This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21504
21505The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21506HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21507participates in the work of HAProxy.
21508
21509filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21510
21511 Arguments :
21512
21513 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21514 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21515 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21516 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21517 OpenTracing filters.
21518
21519 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21520 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21521 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21522 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21523 filter must have its own scope defined.
21524
21525More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021526of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021527
21528
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002152910. FastCGI applications
21530-------------------------
21531
21532HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21533feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21534the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21535FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21536servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21537FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21538backend.
21539
21540HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21541application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21542connection.
21543
2154410.1. Setup
21545-----------
21546
2154710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21548--------------------------
21549
21550fcgi-app <name>
21551 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21552 document root must be defined.
21553
21554acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21555 Declare or complete an access list.
21556
21557 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21558 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21559 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21560 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21561 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21562
21563docroot <path>
21564 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21565 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21566 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21567
21568index <script-name>
21569 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21570 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21571 is an optional setting.
21572
21573 Example :
21574 index index.php
21575
21576log-stderr global
21577log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021578 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021579 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21580
21581 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21582 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21583
21584pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21585 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21586 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21587 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21588
21589 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21590 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21591 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21592 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21593
21594 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21595 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21596
21597path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021598 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021599 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21600 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21601 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21602 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21603 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21604 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21605 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021606
21607 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021608 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021609 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21610 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21611 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21612 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021613
21614 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021615 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21616 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021617
21618option get-values
21619no option get-values
21620 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21621
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021622 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021623 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21624
21625 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21626 application will accept.
21627
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021628 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21629 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021630
21631 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021632 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021633 option is disabled.
21634
21635 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21636 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21637 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21638 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21639 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21640 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21641
21642option keep-conn
21643no option keep-conn
21644 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21645 sending a response.
21646
21647 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21648 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21649
21650option max-reqs <reqs>
21651 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21652 accept.
21653
21654 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21655 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21656 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21657 to 1.
21658
21659option mpxs-conns
21660no option mpxs-conns
21661 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21662
21663 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21664 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21665
21666set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21667 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21668 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21669 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21670 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21671
21672 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21673 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21674 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21675
21676 Example :
21677 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21678 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21679
21680 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21681
21682
2168310.1.2. Proxy section
21684---------------------
21685
21686use-fcgi-app <name>
21687 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21688
21689 Arguments :
21690 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21691
21692 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21693 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21694 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21695 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21696 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21697
21698 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21699 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21700 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21701 application are evaluated.
21702
21703
2170410.1.3. Example
21705---------------
21706
21707 frontend front-http
21708 mode http
21709 bind *:80
21710 bind *:
21711
21712 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21713 default_backend back-static
21714
21715 backend back-static
21716 mode http
21717 server www A.B.C.D:80
21718
21719 backend back-dynamic
21720 mode http
21721 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21722 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21723
21724 fcgi-app php-fpm
21725 log-stderr global
21726 option keep-conn
21727
21728 docroot /var/www/my-app
21729 index index.php
21730 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21731
21732
2173310.2. Default parameters
21734------------------------
21735
21736A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21737the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021738script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021739applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21740
21741 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21742 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21743 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21744 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21745 | | |
21746 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21747 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21748 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21749 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21750 | | application. |
21751 | | |
21752 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21753 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21754 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21755 | | |
21756 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21757 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21758 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21759 | | the application's configuration. |
21760 | | |
21761 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21762 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21763 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21764 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21765 | | |
21766 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21767 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21768 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21769 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21770 | | be defined. |
21771 | | |
21772 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21773 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21774 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21775 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21776 | | is not set too. |
21777 | | |
21778 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21779 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21780 | | set. |
21781 | | |
21782 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21783 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21784 | | the request. |
21785 | | |
21786 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21787 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21788 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21789 | | |
21790 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21791 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21792 | | script to process the request. |
21793 | | |
21794 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21795 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21796 | | |
21797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21798 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21799 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21800 | | |
21801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21802 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21803 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21804 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21805 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21806 | | |
21807 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21808 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21809 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21810 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21811 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21812 | | side. |
21813 | | |
21814 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21815 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21816 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21817 | | connected to. |
21818 | | |
21819 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21820 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21821 | | |
21822 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21823 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21824 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21825 | | |
21826 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21827
21828
2182910.3. Limitations
21830------------------
21831
21832The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21833way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21834during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21835establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21836application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21837or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21838message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21839these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21840and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21841
21842Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21843request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21844requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21845
21846About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21847into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21848fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21849"http-request" ones.
21850
21851Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21852FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21853processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21854must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21855here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021856
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021857
2185811. Address formats
21859-------------------
21860
21861Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21862address.
21863
21864This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21865The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21866of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21867equivalent is '::'.
21868
21869Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21870is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21871
21872This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21873family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21874
21875Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21876configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21877use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21878'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21879
21880Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21881socket type and the transport method.
21882
21883
2188411.1 Address family prefixes
21885----------------------------
21886
21887'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21888
21889'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21890 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21891 listening.
21892
21893'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21894 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21895 on the statement using this address, a port or
21896 a port range may or must be specified.
21897
21898'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21899 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21900 using this address, a port or a port range
21901 may or must be specified.
21902
21903'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21904 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21905 using this address, a port or a port range
21906 may or must be specified.
21907
21908'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21909 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21910 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21911 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21912 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21913 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21914
21915'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21916 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21917 start by slash '/'.
21918
21919
2192011.2 Socket type prefixes
21921-------------------------
21922
21923Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21924type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21925this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21926This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21927but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21928
21929Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21930instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21931
21932If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21933they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21934report this to the maintainers.
21935
21936'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21937 to "stream"
21938
21939'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21940 to "datagram".
21941
21942
2194311.3 Protocol prefixes
21944----------------------
21945
21946'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21947 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21948 socket type and transport method is forced to
21949 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21950 this address, a port or a port range can or
21951 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21952 of 'stream+ip@'.
21953
21954'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21955 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21956 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21957 statement using this address, a port or port
21958 range can or must be specified.
21959 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21960
21961'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21962 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21963 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21964 statement using this address, a port or port
21965 range can or must be specified.
21966 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21967
21968'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21969 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21970 socket type and transport method is forced to
21971 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21972 this address, a port or a port range can or
21973 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21974 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21975
21976'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21977 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21978 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21979 the statement using this address, a port or
21980 port range can or must be specified.
21981 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21982
21983'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21984 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21985 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21986 the statement using this address, a port or
21987 port range can or must be specified.
21988 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21989
21990'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21991 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21992 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21993
21994'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21995 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21996 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21997
21998In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21999QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22000
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022001/*
22002 * Local variables:
22003 * fill-column: 79
22004 * End:
22005 */